blob: a3f3e461869ca694ee2a4785fc7ab33917fea0c8 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau73dec762021-11-23 15:50:11 +01005 version 2.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua8b10652022-04-16 12:15:47 +02007 2022/04/16
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
1048.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600616quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600695that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600700Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
701if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
702or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
703
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
706 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
707
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100708When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
709double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600710and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100711a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
712a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
713the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
714regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
715around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
716more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200717
718
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007192.3. Environment variables
720--------------------------
721
722HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
723interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
724configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
725optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
726shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200727underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
728list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
729arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100730before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
731use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
732next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
733existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200734
735 Example:
736
737 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
738
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100739 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
742
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200743Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
744file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200745
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200746* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
747 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
748
749* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
750 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
751 directory.
752
753* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
754
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500755* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200756 processes, separated by semicolons.
757
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500758* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200759 CLI, separated by semicolons.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200817Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
818See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
819
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200820The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
821expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100822
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100823 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
824 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200826 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530827 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
828 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200829 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
830 from left to right until one returns false
831 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
832 from right to left until one returns true
833
834Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
835operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836
837The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
838
839 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
840 exists, regardless of its contents
841
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200842 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
843 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
844 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
845
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200846 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
847 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
848
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200849 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
850 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
851 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
852 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
853
854 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
855 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
856 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
857 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
858
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200859Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100860
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200861 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
862 listen mwcli_px
863 bind :1111
864 ...
865 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200867 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
868 bind :80
869 .endif
870
871 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200872 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200873 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200874 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200875 .endif
876
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200877 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200878 bind :443 ssl crt ...
879 .endif
880
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200881 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
882 profiling.memory on
883 .endif
884
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200885 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
886 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
887 .endif
888
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200889Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100892 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
893 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
894 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
895
896Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
897"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
898fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
899provide advice to the user.
900
901Example:
902
903 .if "${A}"
904 .if "${B}"
905 .notice "A=1, B=1"
906 .elif "${C}"
907 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
908 .elif "${D}"
909 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
910 .else
911 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
912 .endif
913 .else
914 .notice "A=0"
915 .endif
916
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200917 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
918 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
919
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100920
9212.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200922----------------
923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100924Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100925values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
926otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
927numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
928for every keyword. Supported units are :
929
930 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
931 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
932 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
933 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
934 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
935 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
936
937
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009382.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200939-------------
940
941 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
942 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
943 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
944 global
945 daemon
946 maxconn 256
947
948 defaults
949 mode http
950 timeout connect 5000ms
951 timeout client 50000ms
952 timeout server 50000ms
953
954 frontend http-in
955 bind *:80
956 default_backend servers
957
958 backend servers
959 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
960
961
962 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
963 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
964 global
965 daemon
966 maxconn 256
967
968 defaults
969 mode http
970 timeout connect 5000ms
971 timeout client 50000ms
972 timeout server 50000ms
973
974 listen http-in
975 bind *:80
976 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
977
978
979Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
980
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100981 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200982
983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009843. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985--------------------
986
987Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
988are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
989of them have command-line equivalents.
990
991The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
992
993 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200994 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200996 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200997 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200999 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - description
1001 - deviceatlas-json-file
1002 - deviceatlas-log-level
1003 - deviceatlas-separator
1004 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001005 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001006 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001008 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001009 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001010 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001011 - h1-case-adjust
1012 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001013 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001014 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001015 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001016 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001017 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001020 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001021 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001022 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001023 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001024 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001025 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001027 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001029 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001030 - presetenv
1031 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032 - uid
1033 - ulimit-n
1034 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001035 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001036 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001037 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001038 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001039 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001040 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001041 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001042 - ssl-default-bind-options
1043 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001044 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001045 - ssl-default-server-options
1046 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001047 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001048 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001049 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001050 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001051 - 51degrees-data-file
1052 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001053 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001054 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001055 - wurfl-data-file
1056 - wurfl-information-list
1057 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001058 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001059 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001062 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001063 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001065 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001066 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001067 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001068 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001069 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001070 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001071 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001072 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001073 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001074 - noepoll
1075 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001076 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001077 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001078 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001079 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001080 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001081 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001082 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001083 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001084 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001085 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001086 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001087 - tune.buffers.limit
1088 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001089 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001090 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001091 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001092 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001093 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001094 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001095 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001096 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001097 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001098 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001099 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001100 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001101 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001102 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1103 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001104 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001105 - tune.maxaccept
1106 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001107 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001108 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001109 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001110 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1111 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001112 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1113 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001114 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001115 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001116 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001117 - tune.sndbuf.client
1118 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001119 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001120 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001121 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001122 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001123 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001124 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001125 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001126 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1127 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001128 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001129 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001130 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1131 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1132 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001133 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1134 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001135
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001138 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001139
1140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011413.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001142------------------------------------
1143
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001144ca-base <dir>
1145 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001146 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1147 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1148 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001149
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001150chroot <jail dir>
1151 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1152 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1153 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1154 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1155 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001156 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001157
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001158close-spread-time <time>
1159 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1160 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1161 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1162 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1163 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1164 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1165 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1166 set <time>.
1167
1168 Arguments :
1169 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
1170 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation.
1171
1172 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1173 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1174 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1175
1176 See also: grace, hard-stop-after
1177
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001178cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001179 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001180 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1181 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1182 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1183 set. These sets have the format
1184
1185 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1186
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001187 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1188 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001189 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001190 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001191 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1192 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001193 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1194 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1195 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1196 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1197 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1198 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1199 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1200 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1201 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1202 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001203
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001204 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1205 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1206 on the machine's word size.
1207
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001208 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001209 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1210 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1211 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1212 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1213 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1214 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001215
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001216 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1217 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1218 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1219 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001220
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001221 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001222 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1223 # first 4 CPUs
1224
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001225 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1226 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001227 # word size.
1228
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001229 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1230 # and so on.
1231 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1232 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1233 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1234
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001235 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1236 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1237 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1238 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001239
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001240 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1241 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1242 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001243
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001244crt-base <dir>
1245 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001246 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1247 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001248
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001249daemon
1250 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1251 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001252 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1253 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001254
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001255default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001256 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001257 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1258 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1259 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1260 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1261 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1262 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1263 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1264 not start with a slash ('/'):
1265 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1266 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1267
1268 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1269 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1270 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1271 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1272 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1273 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1274 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1275 each of them.
1276
1277 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1278 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1279 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1280 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1281 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1282 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1283 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1284 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1285
1286 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1287 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001288 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001289 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1290 made easily relocatable.
1291
1292 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1293 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1294 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1295 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1296 consistent across all configuration files.
1297
1298 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1299 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1300 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1301 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1302 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1303 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1304 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1305 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1306
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001307deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1308 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001309 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001310
1311deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001312 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001313 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1314
1315deviceatlas-separator <char>
1316 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1317 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1318
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001319deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001320 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1321 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1322 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001323
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001324expose-experimental-directives
1325 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1326 the config file will be rejected.
1327
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001328external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001329 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1330 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001331 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1332 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1333 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1334 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1335 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001337gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001338 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001339 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1340 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001341 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001342 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001343 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001344
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001345grace <time>
1346 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1347
1348 Arguments :
1349 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1350 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1351 soft-stop operation.
1352
1353 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1354 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1355 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1356 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1357 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1358 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1359 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1360 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1361 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1362
1363 Example:
1364
1365 global
1366 grace 10s
1367
1368 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1369 frontend ext-check
1370 bind :9999
1371 monitor-uri /ext-check
1372 monitor fail if { stopping }
1373
1374 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1375 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1376 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1377 SIGUSR1 signal.
1378
1379 Example:
1380
1381 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1382 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1383 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1384 frontend ext-check
1385 bind :9999
1386 monitor-uri /ext-check
1387 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1388
1389 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1390
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001391group <group name>
1392 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1393 See also "gid" and "user".
1394
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001395hard-stop-after <time>
1396 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1397
1398 Arguments :
1399 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1400 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1401 SIGUSR1 signal.
1402
1403 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1404 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1405 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1406
1407 Example:
1408 global
1409 hard-stop-after 30s
1410
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001411 See also: grace
1412
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001413h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1414 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1415 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1416 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1417 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001418 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001419 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1420 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1421 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1422 specified in a proxy.
1423
1424 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1425 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1426 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1427 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1428 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1429 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1430 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1431
1432 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1433 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1434 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1435 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1436 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1437
1438 Example:
1439 global
1440 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1441
1442 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1443 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1444
1445h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1446 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1447 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1448 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1449 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1450 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1451 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1452 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1453 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1454
1455 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1456 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1457 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1458
1459 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1460 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1461
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001462insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001463 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001464 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1465 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1466 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1467 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1468 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1469 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1470 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001471 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001472 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1473 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1474 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1475 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1476 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1477 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1478 disable it.
1479
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001480insecure-setuid-wanted
1481 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1482 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1483 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1484 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001485 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001486 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001487 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001488 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1489 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001490 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001491 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1492 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1493 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1494 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1495
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001496issuers-chain-path <dir>
1497 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1498 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1499 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001500 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001501 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1502 "issuers-chain-path".
1503 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1504 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1505 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1506 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1507 will share the chain in memory.
1508
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001509h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1510 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1511 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1512 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1513 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1514 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1515 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1516 the keyword with "no'.
1517
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001518localpeer <name>
1519 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1520 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1521 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1522 the configuration parsing.
1523
1524 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1525 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1526
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001527log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001528 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001529 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001530 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001531 configured with "log global".
1532
1533 <address> can be one of:
1534
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001535 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001536 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1537 port).
1538
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001539 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1540 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1541 port).
1542
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001543 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001544 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1545 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001546 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001547
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001548 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1549 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1550 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1551 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1552 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1553 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1554 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1555 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1556 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1557 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001558 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001559 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1560 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1561 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001562 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1563 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001564
1565 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1566 "fd@2", see above.
1567
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001568 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1569 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1570 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1571 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1572 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1573
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001574 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1575 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001576
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001577 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1578 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1579 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1580 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1581 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1582 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1583 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1584 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1585 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1586 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001587 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1588 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001589
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001590 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1591 one of the following :
1592
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001593 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1594 field is stripped. This is the default.
1595 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1596 rfc3164.
1597
1598 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001599 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1600
1601 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1602 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1603
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001604 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1605 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1606 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1607 designed to be used with a local log server.
1608
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001609 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1610 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1611 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1612 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1613 logger consumes.
1614
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001615 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1616 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1617 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1618 used with a local log server.
1619
1620 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1621 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1622 designed to be used with a local log server.
1623
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001624 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1625 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1626 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1627 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1628
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001629 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1630 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1631 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1632 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1633 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1634
1635 <sample_size>
1636 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1637 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1638 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1639 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1640 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1641
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001642 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001643
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001644 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1645 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1646 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1647
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001648 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1649 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1650 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1651 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001652
1653 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001654 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1655 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1656 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1657 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1658 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1659 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001660
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001661 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001662
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001663log-send-hostname [<string>]
1664 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1665 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1666 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1667 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1668 the logs.
1669
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001670log-tag <string>
1671 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1672 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1673 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001674 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001675
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001676lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001677 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1678 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1679 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1680 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1681 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1682 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001683 used multiple times.
1684
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001685lua-load-per-thread <file>
1686 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1687 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1688 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1689 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1690 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1691 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1692 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1693 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1694 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1695 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1696 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1697 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1698 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1699 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1700 times.
1701
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001702lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1703 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1704 variable.
1705 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1706 to "path".
1707
1708 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1709 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1710 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1711 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1712 will be checked earlier.
1713
1714 As an example by specifying the following path:
1715
1716 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1717 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1718
1719 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1720 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1721 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1722 paths if that does not exist either.
1723
1724 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1725 documentation.
1726
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001727master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001728 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1729 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1730 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001731 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001732 or daemon mode.
1733
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001734 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1735 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1736 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1737 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1738 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001739
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001740 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001741
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001742mworker-max-reloads <number>
1743 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001744 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001745 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1746 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1747 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1748
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001749nbthread <number>
1750 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001751 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1752 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1753 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1754 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1755 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1756 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1757 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001758
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001759numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001760 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1761 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1762 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1763 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1764 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1765 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1766 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1767 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1768 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1769 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001771pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001772 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1773 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1774 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1775 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001776
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001777pp2-never-send-local
1778 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1779 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1780 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1781 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1782 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1783 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1784 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1785 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1786 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1787 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1788 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1789
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001790presetenv <name> <value>
1791 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1792 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1793 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1794 and "unsetenv".
1795
1796resetenv [<name> ...]
1797 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1798 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1799 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1800 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1801 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1802 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1803 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1804 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1805
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001806stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001807 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1808 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1809 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001810
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001811server-state-base <directory>
1812 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001813 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1814 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001815
1816server-state-file <file>
1817 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1818 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1819 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1820 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1821 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1822 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1823 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1824 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001825 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1826 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001827
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001828set-var <var-name> <expr>
1829 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1830 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1831 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1832 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1833 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1834 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001835 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001836 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1837 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1838
1839 Example:
1840 global
1841 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1842 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1843 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1844
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001845set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1846 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1847 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1848 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1849 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1850 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1851 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1852 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1853 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1854 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1855 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1856
1857 Example:
1858 global
1859 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1860 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1861
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001862setenv <name> <value>
1863 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1864 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1865 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1866 and "unsetenv".
1867
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001868set-dumpable
1869 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001870 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1871 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1872 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1873 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1874 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1875 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1876 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1877 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1878 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1879 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1880 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1881 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1882 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1883 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1884 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001885 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001886 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001887
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001888ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1890 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001891 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001892 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001893 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1894 information and recommendations see e.g.
1895 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1896 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1897 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1898 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001899
1900ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1902 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1903 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1904 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1905 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001906 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1907 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1908 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001909 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001910
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001911ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1913 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1914 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1915 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1916 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1917
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001918ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1919 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1920 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1921 keyword to see available options.
1922
1923 Example:
1924 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001925 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001926
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001927ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1929 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001930 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001931 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001932 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1933 information and recommendations see e.g.
1934 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1935 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1936 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1937 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1938 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001939
1940ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1942 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1943 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1944 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1945 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001946 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1947 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1948 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1949 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001950
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001951ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1952 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1953 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1954 keyword to see available options.
1955
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001956ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1957 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1958 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1959 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001960 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001961 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001962 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02001963 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
1964 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
1965 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
1966 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001967 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1968 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1969 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1970
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001971ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1972 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1973 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001974 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001975 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001976 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1977
1978 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001979
1980 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1981 and won't try to remove them.
1982
1983 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1984
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001985ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001986 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001987 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1988 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1989 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001990
1991 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1992 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1993 optimize the startup time.
1994
1995 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1996 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1997 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1998
1999 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002000 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002001
2002 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002003 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2004 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002005
2006 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2007 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2008 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2009 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2010 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002011 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002012
2013 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002014 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002015 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2016 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2017 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2018 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2019 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002020 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002021
2022 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2023
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002024 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002025 a cert bundle.
2026
2027 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2028 separately in several "crt".
2029
2030 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2031 since files are loading separately.
2032
2033 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2034 required to commit them.
2035
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002036 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002037 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002038
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002039 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2040 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2041 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002042
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002043 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2044 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2045 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002046
2047 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002048 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2049 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002050
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002051 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2052 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2053
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002054 The default behavior is "all".
2055
2056 Example:
2057 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2058 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2059 ssl-load-extra-files none
2060
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002061 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2062 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002063
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002064ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2065 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2066 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2067 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2068
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002069ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002070 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002071 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2072 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2073 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2074 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2075 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2076 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002077 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002078
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002079stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2080 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2081 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2082 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002083 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002084 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002085
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002086 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2087 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2088 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002089
2090stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2091 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2092 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002093 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002094
2095stats maxconn <connections>
2096 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2097 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2098
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002099thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2100 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2101 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2102 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2103 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2104 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2105 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2106 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2107 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2108 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2109
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002110thread-groups <number>
2111 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2112 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
2113 moment, the limit is 1 and is also the default value. See also "nbthread".
2114
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002115uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002116 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002117 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2118 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2119 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2120
2121ulimit-n <number>
2122 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2123 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2124 option.
2125
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002126 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2127 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2128 manually specify this value.
2129
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002130unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2131 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2132
2133 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2134 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2135 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2136 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2137 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002138 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002139 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2140 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2141 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2142 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2143
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002144unsetenv [<name> ...]
2145 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2146 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2147 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2148 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2149 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2150 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2151 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2152
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002153user <user name>
2154 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2155 See also "uid" and "group".
2156
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002157node <name>
2158 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2159
2160 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2161 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2162 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2163 traffic.
2164
2165description <text>
2166 Add a text that describes the instance.
2167
2168 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2169 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2170 "<" and ">" characters.
2171
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100217251degrees-data-file <file path>
2173 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002174 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002175
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002176 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002177 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2178
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000217951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002180 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2181 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2182 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2183
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002184 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002185 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2186
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200218751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002188 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2189 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2190
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002191 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002192 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2193
219451degrees-cache-size <number>
2195 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2196 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2197 By default, this cache is disabled.
2198
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002199 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002200 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2201
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002202wurfl-data-file <file path>
2203 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2204 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2205
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002206 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002207 with USE_WURFL=1.
2208
2209wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2210 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2211 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2212 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2213
2214 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2215
2216 Valid WURFL properties are:
2217 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2218
2219 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2220 device.
2221
2222 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2223 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2224
2225 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2226 particular web request.
2227
2228 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2229 used Libwurfl API version.
2230
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002231 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2232 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2233
2234 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2235 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2236
2237 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2238
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002239 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002240 with USE_WURFL=1.
2241
2242wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2243 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2244 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2245
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002246 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002247 with USE_WURFL=1.
2248
2249wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2250 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2251 thus before the chroot.
2252
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002253 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002254 with USE_WURFL=1.
2255
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002256wurfl-cache-size <size>
2257 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2258 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002259 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002260 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002261
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002262 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002263 with USE_WURFL=1.
2264
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002265strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002266 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002267 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2268 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002269 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002270 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022723.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002273-----------------------
2274
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002275busy-polling
2276 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2277 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2278 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2279 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2280 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2281 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2282 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2283 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2284 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2285 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2286 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2287 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2288 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2289 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2290 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2291 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2292 "poll" pollers.
2293
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002294 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2295 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2296 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2297
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002298max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002299 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002300 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2301 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2302 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2303 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2304 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2305 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2306 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2307
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002308maxconn <number>
2309 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2310 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2311 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002312 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2313 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2314 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2315 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002316 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2317 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2318 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2319 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2320 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2321 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002322
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002323maxconnrate <number>
2324 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2325 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2326 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2327 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2328 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2329 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2330 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2331 fairness.
2332
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002333maxcomprate <number>
2334 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002335 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002336 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2337 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2338 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002339 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002340 default value.
2341
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002342maxcompcpuusage <number>
2343 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2344 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2345 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002346 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2347 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2348 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2349 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002350
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002351maxpipes <number>
2352 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2353 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2354 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2355 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2356 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2357 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2358
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002359maxsessrate <number>
2360 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2361 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2362 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2363 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2364 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2365 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2366 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2367 fairness.
2368
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002369maxsslconn <number>
2370 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2371 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2372 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2373 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2374 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2375 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2376 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002377 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2378 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2379 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2380 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002381 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002382 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2383 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002384
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002385maxsslrate <number>
2386 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2387 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2388 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2389 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2390 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2391 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2392 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2393 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2394 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2395 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2396
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002397maxzlibmem <number>
2398 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2399 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2400 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002401 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2402 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2403 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2404
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002405no-memory-trimming
2406 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2407 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2408 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2409 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2410 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2411 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2412 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2413 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2414 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2415 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2416 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2417 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2418 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2419 not suffer from such a problem.
2420
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002421noepoll
2422 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2423 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002424 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002425
2426nokqueue
2427 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2428 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2429 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2430
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002431noevports
2432 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2433 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2434 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2435 also "nopoll".
2436
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002437nopoll
2438 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2439 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002440 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002441 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2442 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002443
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002444nosplice
2445 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002446 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002447 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002448 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002449 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2450 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2451 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2452 "option splice-response".
2453
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002454nogetaddrinfo
2455 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2456 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2457
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002458noreuseport
2459 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2460 command line argument "-dR".
2461
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002462profiling.memory { on | off }
2463 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2464 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2465 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2466 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2467 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2468 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2469 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2470 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2471 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2472
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002473profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2474 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2475 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2476 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2477 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002478 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002479 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2480 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2481 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2482 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2483
2484 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2485 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2486 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2487 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2488 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002489 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2490 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2491 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2492 CLI.
2493
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002494spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002495 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2496 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2497 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2498 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2499 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2500 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002501
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002502ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002503 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002504 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002505 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002506 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002507 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2508 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2509 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002510 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2511 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002512 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2513 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2514 openssl configuration file uses:
2515 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2516
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002517ssl-mode-async
2518 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002519 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002520 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2521 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002522 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002523 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002524 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002525
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002526tune.buffers.limit <number>
2527 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2528 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2529 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2530 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2531 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002532 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002533 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2534 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2535 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2536 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2537 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2538 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2539 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2540 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002541 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002542
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002543tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2544 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2545 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2546 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002547 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002548
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002549tune.bufsize <number>
2550 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2551 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2552 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2553 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2554 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2555 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2556 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002557 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2558 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002559 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002560 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002561 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002562 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2563 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002564
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002565tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2566 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2567 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2568 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2569 this value. The default value is 1.
2570
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002571tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002572 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2573 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2574 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2575 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002576
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002577tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2578 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2579 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2580 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2581 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2582 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2583
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002584tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2585 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2586 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2587 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2588 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2589 change it.
2590
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002591tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2592 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002593 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002594 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002595 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2596 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2597 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2598 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2599 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2600
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002601tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2602 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2603 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2604 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2605 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2606 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002607 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002608 recommended not to change this value.
2609
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002610tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002611 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002612 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002613 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002614 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2615 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2616 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2617 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2618
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002619tune.http.cookielen <number>
2620 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2621 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2622 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2623 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2624 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2625 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2626 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2627 to change this value.
2628
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002629tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002630 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2631 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002632 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002633 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002634 configuration directives too.
2635 The default value is 1024.
2636
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002637tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2638 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2639 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2640 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2641 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2642 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2643 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002644 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2645 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2646 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002647
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002648tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2649 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2650 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2651 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2652 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2653 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2654 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002655 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2656 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2657 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2658 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2659 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002660
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002661tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002662 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002663 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2664 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2665 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2666 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002667 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002668 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002669 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002670 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2671
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002672tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2673 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2674 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2675 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2676 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2677 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2678 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2679 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2680 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2681 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2682
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002683tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2684 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002685 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002686 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2687 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002688 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002689 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2690 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2691
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002692tune.lua.maxmem
2693 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2694 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2695 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2696 memory.
2697
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002698tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2699 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002700 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2701 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002702 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002703
2704tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2705 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2706 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2707 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2708 check servers.
2709
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002710tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2711 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2712 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2713 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002714 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002715
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002716tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002717 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2718 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002719 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2720 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2721 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2722 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2723 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2724 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2725 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2726 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2727 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002728
2729tune.maxpollevents <number>
2730 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2731 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2732 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2733 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2734 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2735
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002736tune.maxrewrite <number>
2737 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2738 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2739 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2740 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2741 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2742 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2743 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2744 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2745 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2746 bufsize.
2747
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002748tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2749 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2750 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2751 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2752 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2753 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2754 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2755 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2756 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2757 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002758 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2759 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002760 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2761 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2762 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2763 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2764 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2765 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2766 setting this parameter to 0.
2767
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002768tune.pipesize <number>
2769 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2770 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2771 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2772 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2773 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2774 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2775
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002776tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2777 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002778 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002779 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2780 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2781 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2782 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002783 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002784
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002785tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2786 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002787 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002788 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2789 default is 20.
2790
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002791tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2792tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2793 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2794 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2795 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002796 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002797 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002798 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2799 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2800
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002801tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002802 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002803 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2804 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2805 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2806 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2807
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002808tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002809 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002810 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2811 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2812 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2813 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2814 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2815 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2816 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002817
2818tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2819 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002820 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002821 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2822 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2823 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2824 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2825 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2826 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2827 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002828
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002829tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2830tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2831 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2832 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2833 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002834 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002835 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002836 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2837 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2838 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2839 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002840 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002841
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002842tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002843 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002844 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2845 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2846 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2847 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2848 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2849 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2850 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2851 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2852 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002853 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2854 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002855
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002856tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002857 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002858 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2859 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2860 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2861 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2862 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2863
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002864tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2865 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2866 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2867 performances. This is disabled by default.
2868
2869 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2870 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2871
2872 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2873
2874 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2875
2876 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2877
2878 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2879 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2880 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2881
2882 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2883 converted.
2884
2885 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2886 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2887 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2888 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2889 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2890 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2891 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002892 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2893 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002894
2895 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2896
2897 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2898 only need this line:
2899
2900 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2901
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002902tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2903 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002904 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002905 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2906 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2907 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2908 being used for too long.
2909
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002910tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2911 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2912 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2913 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2914 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2915 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2916 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2917 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2918 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2919 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2920 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002921 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002922 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002923
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002924tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2925 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2926 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2927 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2928 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002929 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2930 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2931 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2932 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2933 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2934 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2935 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2936 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002937
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002938tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2939 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2940 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2941 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2942 1000 entries.
2943
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002944tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2945tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002946 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2947 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2948 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2949 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002950
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002951tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002952tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002953tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2954tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2955tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002956 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2957 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2958 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2959 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2960 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2961 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2962 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2963 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002964
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002965 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2966 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2967 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2968 all available space is consumed.
2969 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2970 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2971 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002972
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002973tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2974 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002975 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002976 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002977 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002978 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2979
2980tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2981 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2982 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002983 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2984 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002985
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029863.3. Debugging
2987--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002988
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002989quiet
2990 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2991 line argument "-q".
2992
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002993zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002994 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002995 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2996 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2997 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2998 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2999 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3000
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010030023.4. Userlists
3003--------------
3004It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3005http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3006it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3007
3008userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003009 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003010 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3011
3012group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003013 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003014 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3015 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3016
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003017user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3018 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003019 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3020 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003021 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3022 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3023 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3024 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003025
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003026 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3027 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3028 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3029 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3030 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3031 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3032 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003033 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003034 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003035
3036 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003037 userlist L1
3038 group G1 users tiger,scott
3039 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003040
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003041 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3042 user scott insecure-password elgato
3043 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003044
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003045 userlist L2
3046 group G1
3047 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003048
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003049 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3050 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3051 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003052
3053 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003054
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003055
30563.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003057----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003058It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003059several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003060instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003061values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3062type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3063values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3064active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3065switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3066present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3067watch it.
3068
3069Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3070known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3071the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3072process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3073during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3074tables.
3075
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003076Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3077that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3078each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003079
3080peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003081 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003082 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3083
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003084bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3085 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3086 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3087
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003088disabled
3089 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3090 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3091 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3092
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003093default-bind [param*]
3094 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3095
3096default-server [param*]
3097 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3098
3099 Arguments:
3100 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3101 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3102 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3103 details.
3104
3105
3106 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3107
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003108enabled
3109 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3110 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003111
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003112log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003113 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3114 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3115 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3116 more details.
3117
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003118peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003119 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3120 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003121 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003122 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003123 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3124 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3125 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003126
3127 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3128 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3129
3130 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003131 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3132 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3133 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003134
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003135 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3136 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003137
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003138 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3139 "server" keyword explanation below).
3140
3141server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003142 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003143 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3144 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +02003145 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003146 of this "peers" section).
3147 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3148
3149
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003150 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003151 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003152 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003153 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3154 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3155 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003156
3157 backend mybackend
3158 mode tcp
3159 balance roundrobin
3160 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3161 stick on src
3162
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003163 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3164 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003165
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003166 Example:
3167 peers mypeers
3168 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3169 default-server ssl verify none
3170 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3171 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003172
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003173
3174table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3175 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3176
3177 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3178 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003179 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003180 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3181 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3182 "stick-table" keyword).
3183
3184 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3185 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3186 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3187 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3188 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3189 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3190 of the stick-table name as follows:
3191
3192 peers mypeers
3193 peer A ...
3194 peer B ...
3195 table t1 ...
3196
3197 frontend fe1
3198 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3199
3200 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3201 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3202
3203 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3204 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3205 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3206 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3207 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3208 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3209 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3210
3211 peers mypeers
3212 peer A ...
3213 peer B ...
3214 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3215
3216 backend t1
3217 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3218
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003219 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003220 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3221 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3222
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090032233.6. Mailers
3224------------
3225It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3226If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3227in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3228
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003229mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003230 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3231 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3232
3233mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3234 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3235
3236 Example:
3237 mailers mymailers
3238 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3239 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3240
3241 backend mybackend
3242 mode tcp
3243 balance roundrobin
3244
3245 email-alert mailers mymailers
3246 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3247 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3248
3249 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3250 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3251
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003252timeout mail <time>
3253 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3254 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3255 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3256 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3257
3258 Example:
3259 mailers mymailers
3260 timeout mail 20s
3261 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003262
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020032633.7. Programs
3264-------------
3265In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3266master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3267managed the same way as the workers.
3268
3269During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3270sequence as a worker:
3271
3272 - the master is re-executed
3273 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3274 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3275 instance of the program
3276
3277During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3278
3279program <name>
3280 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3281 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3282 the management guide).
3283
3284command <command> [arguments*]
3285 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3286 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3287 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3288 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3289
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003290user <user name>
3291 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3292 See also "group".
3293
3294group <group name>
3295 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3296 See also "user".
3297
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003298option start-on-reload
3299no option start-on-reload
3300 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3301 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3302 program section.
3303
3304
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010033053.8. HTTP-errors
3306----------------
3307
3308It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3309imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3310several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3311
3312http-errors <name>
3313 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3314 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3315
3316errorfile <code> <file>
3317 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3318
3319 Arguments :
3320 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003321 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003322 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003323
3324 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3325 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3326 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3327 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3328 before any chroot is performed.
3329
3330 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3331
3332 Example:
3333 http-errors website-1
3334 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3335 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3336 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3337
3338 http-errors website-2
3339 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3340 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3341 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3342
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020033433.9. Rings
3344----------
3345
3346It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3347servers or traces.
3348
3349ring <ringname>
3350 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3351
3352description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003353 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003354 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3355
3356format <format>
3357 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3358
3359 Arguments:
3360 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3361 one of the following :
3362
3363 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3364 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3365 designed to be used with a local log server.
3366
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003367 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3368 field is stripped. This is the default.
3369 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3370 rfc3164.
3371
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003372 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3373 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3374 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3375 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3376 is the default.
3377
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003378 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003379 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3380
3381 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3382 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3383
3384 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3385 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3386 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3387 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3388 logger consumes.
3389
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003390 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3391 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3392 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3393 with a local log server.
3394
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003395 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3396 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3397 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3398 used with a local log server.
3399
3400maxlen <length>
3401 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3402 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3403 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3404
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003405server <name> <address> [param*]
3406 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3407 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3408 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3409 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3410 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3411 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3412 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3413 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3414 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003415 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3416 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003417
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003418size <size>
3419 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3420 set to BUFSIZE.
3421
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003422timeout connect <timeout>
3423 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3424
3425 Arguments :
3426 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3427 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3428 as explained at the top of this document.
3429
3430timeout server <timeout>
3431 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3432
3433 Arguments :
3434 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3435 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3436 as explained at the top of this document.
3437
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003438 Example:
3439 global
3440 log ring@myring local7
3441
3442 ring myring
3443 description "My local buffer"
3444 format rfc3164
3445 maxlen 1200
3446 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003447 timeout connect 5s
3448 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003449 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003450
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020034513.10. Log forwarding
3452-------------------
3453
3454It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003455HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003456
3457log-forward <name>
3458 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3459
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003460backlog <conns>
3461 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3462 on connections accept.
3463
3464bind <addr> [param*]
3465 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003466 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3467 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3468 syslog protocol over TCP.
3469 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003470 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3471
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003472dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003473 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3474 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3475 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3476 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003477 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003478
3479log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003480log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003481 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3482 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3483 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003484 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003485 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3486 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3487 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003488 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003489
3490 Example:
3491 global
3492 log stderr format iso local7
3493
3494 ring myring
3495 description "My local buffer"
3496 format rfc5424
3497 maxlen 1200
3498 size 32764
3499 timeout connect 5s
3500 timeout server 10s
3501 # syslog tcp server
3502 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3503
3504 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003505 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3506 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003507 # all messages on stderr
3508 log global
3509 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3510 log ring@myring local0
3511 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3512 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3513 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3514 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3515 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003516
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003517maxconn <conns>
3518 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3519 10 is the default.
3520
3521timeout client <timeout>
3522 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003525----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003526
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003527Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003528 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3529 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3530 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3531 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003532
3533A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3534connections.
3535
3536A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3537to forward incoming connections.
3538
3539A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3540parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3541
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003542A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3543ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3544sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3545the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3546explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3547from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3548"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3549for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3550to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3551optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3552are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3553any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3554names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3555that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3556duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003557names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3558is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3559implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3560encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3561adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003562
3563Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3564settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3565of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3566profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3567timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3568
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3570'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3571case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3572
3573Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3574logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3575proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3576However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3577name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3578
3579Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3580and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003581bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003582protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3583modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3584arbitrary criteria.
3585
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003586In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3587a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003588the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003589
3590 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3591 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3592 between responses and new requests.
3593
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003594 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3595 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3596 client-facing connection remains open.
3597
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003598 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3599 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003600
3601The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3602frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3603following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003604weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003605
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003606 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003607
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003608 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3609 ----+-----+-----+----
3610 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3611 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003612 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3613 ----+-----+-----+----
3614 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003615
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003616It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003617only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3618within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003619as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003620content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003621and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3622possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003623
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003624There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003625first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003626processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003627second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003628protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3629is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3630new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003631to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003632process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3633already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3634HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3635evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3636one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3637
3638There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3639performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3640tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3641preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3642analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3643HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3644header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3645mitigate this drawback.
3646
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003647There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003648method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3649set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3650in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3651is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3652to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3653above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3654to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3655"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3656frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3657frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3658as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3659upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3660on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3661the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3662upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3663frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3664remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036664.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3667--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003669The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3670limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3671they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3672limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003673marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003674option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003675and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3676with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003677specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
3678sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
3679anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003680
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003681
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003682 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3683------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003684acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003685backlog X X X -
3686balance X - X X
3687bind - X X -
3688bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003689capture cookie - X X -
3690capture request header - X X -
3691capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003692clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3693clitcpka-idle X X X -
3694clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003695compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003697declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698default-server X - X X
3699default_backend X X X -
3700description - X X X
3701disabled X X X X
3702dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003703email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003704email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003705email-alert mailers X X X X
3706email-alert myhostname X X X X
3707email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003708enabled X X X X
3709errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003710errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003711errorloc X X X X
3712errorloc302 X X X X
3713-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3714errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003715error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003716force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003717filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003718fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003719hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003720http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003721http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003722http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003724http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003725http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003726http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003727http-check set-var X - X X
3728http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003729http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003730http-request X (!) X X X
3731http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003732http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003733http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003734id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003735ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003736load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003737log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003738log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003739log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003740log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003741max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003742maxconn X X X -
3743mode X X X X
3744monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003745monitor-uri X X X -
3746option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3747option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3748option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3749option allbackups (*) X - X X
3750option checkcache (*) X - X X
3751option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3752option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003753option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003754option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3755option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003756-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3757option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003758option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3759option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003760option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003761option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003762option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003763option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003764option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003765option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3766option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3767option httpchk X - X X
3768option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003769option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003770option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003771option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003772option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003773option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003774option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3775option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3776option logasap (*) X X X -
3777option mysql-check X - X X
3778option nolinger (*) X X X X
3779option originalto X X X X
3780option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003781option pgsql-check X - X X
3782option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003783option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003784option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003785option smtpchk X - X X
3786option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3787option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3788option splice-request (*) X X X X
3789option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003790option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003791option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3792option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3793-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003794option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003795option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3796option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3797option tcpka X X X X
3798option tcplog X X X X
3799option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003800option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003801external-check command X - X X
3802external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003803persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3804rate-limit sessions X X X -
3805redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003806-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003807retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003808retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003809server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003810server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003811server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003812source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003813srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3814srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3815srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003816stats admin - X X X
3817stats auth X X X X
3818stats enable X X X X
3819stats hide-version X X X X
3820stats http-request - X X X
3821stats realm X X X X
3822stats refresh X X X X
3823stats scope X X X X
3824stats show-desc X X X X
3825stats show-legends X X X X
3826stats show-node X X X X
3827stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003828-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3829stick match - - X X
3830stick on - - X X
3831stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003832stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003833stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003834tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003835tcp-check connect X - X X
3836tcp-check expect X - X X
3837tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003838tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003839tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003840tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003841tcp-check set-var X - X X
3842tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003843tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
3844tcp-request content X (!) X X X
3845tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
3846tcp-request session X (!) X X -
3847tcp-response content X (!) - X X
3848tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003849timeout check X - X X
3850timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003851timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003852timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003853timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3854timeout http-request X X X X
3855timeout queue X - X X
3856timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003857timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003858timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003859timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003860transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003861unique-id-format X X X -
3862unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003863use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003864use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003865use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003866------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3867 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020038704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3871---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003872
3873This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3874
3875
3876acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3877 Declare or complete an access list.
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003879 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
3880
3881 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
3882 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
3883 using it.
3884
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003885 Example:
3886 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3887 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3888 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003890 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003891
3892
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003893backlog <conns>
3894 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3896 yes | yes | yes | no
3897 Arguments :
3898 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3899 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003900 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003901
3902 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3903 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3904 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3905 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3906 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3907 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3908 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3909 backlog parameter.
3910
3911 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3912 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3913 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3914
3915 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3916
3917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003918balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003919balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3922 yes | no | yes | yes
3923 Arguments :
3924 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3925 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3926 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3927 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3928
3929 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3930 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3931 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3932 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003933 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003934 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003935 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3936 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3937 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3938 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3939 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3940 it, so that you don't worry.
3941
3942 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3943 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3944 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3945 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3946 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3947 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3948 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3949 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003950
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003951 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3952 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3953 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3954 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3955 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3956 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3957 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003958 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3959 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3960 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003961
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003962 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003963 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003964 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3965 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003966 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003967 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3968 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3969 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3970 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3971 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003972 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3973 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3974 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3975 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3976 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3977 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003979 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3980 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3981 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3982 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3983 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3984 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3985 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3986 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003987 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003988 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003989 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3990 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3991 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003992
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003993 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3994 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3995 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3996 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3997 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3998 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3999 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4000 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4001 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4002 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4003 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4004 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004005
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004006 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004007 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4008 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4009 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4010 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4011 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4012 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4013 URIs start with a leading "/".
4014
4015 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4016 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4017 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4018 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4019
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004020 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4021 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4022 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
4023 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
4024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004025 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004026 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4027
4028 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004029 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4030 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004031 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4032 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4033 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4034 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004035 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004036 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4037 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004038
4039 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4040 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4041 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4042 server will receive the request.
4043
4044 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4045 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4046 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4047 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4048 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004049 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4050 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
4051 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004052
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004053 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4054 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4055 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4056 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4057 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004059 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004060 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4061 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4062 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4063
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004064 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4065 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4066 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4067
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004068 random
4069 random(<draws>)
4070 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004071 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4072 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4073 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4074 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004075 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4076 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4077 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4078 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4079 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4080 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4081 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4082 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4083 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4084 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4085 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4086 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4087 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4088 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4089 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4090 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4091 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4092 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4093 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4094 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004095
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004096 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004097 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004098 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4099 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004100 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004101 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4102 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4103 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004104 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004105 used instead.
4106
4107 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4108 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4109 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004110 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004111
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004112 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4113 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4114 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004116 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004117 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4118 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004119
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004120 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4121 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4122 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004123
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004124 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004125 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004126 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4127 NTLM relies on.
4128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004129 Examples :
4130 balance roundrobin
4131 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004132 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004133 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4134 balance hdr(host)
4135 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004136
4137 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4138 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4139
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004140 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004141 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4142 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4143 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004144 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004145
4146 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4147 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4148 defaults to 16 kB.
4149
4150 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4151 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4152
4153 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4154 Round Robin.
4155
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004156 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004157 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4158 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4159 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4160
4161 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4162
4163 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004164 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004165 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4166 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4167 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004169 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004170
4171
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004172bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4173bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004174 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4176 no | yes | yes | no
4177 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004178 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4179 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4180 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4181 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004182 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004183 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4184 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4185 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4186 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4187 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4188 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004189 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004190 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4191 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004192 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004193 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4194 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004195 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004196 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4197 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004198 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004199 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004200 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4201 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4202 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004203 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4204 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4205 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4206 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004207 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4208 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4209 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004210
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004211 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4212 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004213 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4214 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4215 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004216 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4217 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4218 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4219 the range.
4220
4221 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4222 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4223 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4224 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4225 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4226 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4227 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004228 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004229 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004230
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004231 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004232 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004233 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4234 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4235 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4236 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4237 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4238 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4239
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004240 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4241 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4242 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4243 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004244
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004245 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4246 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4247 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4248 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4249 in a frontend.
4250
4251 Example :
4252 listen http_proxy
4253 bind :80,:443
4254 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004255 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004256
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004257 listen http_https_proxy
4258 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004259 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004260
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004261 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4262 bind ipv6@:80
4263 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4264 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4265
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004266 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004267 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004268
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004269 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4270 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4271 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4272 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4273 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4274
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004275 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004276 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277
4278
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004279bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4281 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004282
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004283 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4284 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4285 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4286 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4287 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4288 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004289
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004290 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004291
4292
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004293capture cookie <name> len <length>
4294 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4296 no | yes | yes | no
4297 Arguments :
4298 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4299 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4300 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4301 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004302 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004303
4304 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4305 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4306 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4307 right if it exceeds <length>.
4308
4309 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4310 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4311 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4312 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4313
4314 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4315 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4316 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4317
4318 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4319 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4320 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004321 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4322 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4323 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004324
4325 Example:
4326 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4327
4328 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004329 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004330
4331
4332capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004333 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4335 no | yes | yes | no
4336 Arguments :
4337 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004338 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004339 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4340 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4341 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4342
4343 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4344 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4345 it exceeds <length>.
4346
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004347 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4349 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004350 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4351 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4352 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4353 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004354 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004355 environments to find where the request came from.
4356
4357 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4358 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4359 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4360 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004361
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004362 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4363 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4364 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4365 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4366 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004367
4368 Example:
4369 capture request header Host len 15
4370 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004371 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004374 about logging.
4375
4376
4377capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004378 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4380 no | yes | yes | no
4381 Arguments :
4382 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004383 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004384 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4385 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4386 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4387
4388 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4389 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4390 it exceeds <length>.
4391
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004392 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004393 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4394 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4395 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004396 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4397 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4398 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4399 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004400
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004401 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4402 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4403 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4404 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4405 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004406
4407 Example:
4408 capture response header Content-length len 9
4409 capture response header Location len 15
4410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004411 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004412 about logging.
4413
4414
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004415clitcpka-cnt <count>
4416 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4417 the connection on the client side.
4418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4419 yes | yes | yes | no
4420 Arguments :
4421 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4422
4423 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4424 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004425 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4426 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004427
4428 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4429
4430
4431clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4432 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4433 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4434 client side.
4435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4436 yes | yes | yes | no
4437 Arguments :
4438 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4439 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4440 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4441 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4442
4443 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4444 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004445 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4446 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004447
4448 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4449
4450
4451clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4452 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4454 yes | yes | yes | no
4455 Arguments :
4456 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4457 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4458 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4459 document.
4460
4461 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4462 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004463 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4464 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004465
4466 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4467
4468
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004469compression algo <algorithm> ...
4470compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004471 Enable HTTP compression.
4472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4473 yes | yes | yes | yes
4474 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004475 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4476 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004477
4478 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004479 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4480 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4481 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004482
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004483 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004484 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004485
4486 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4487 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4488 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4489 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4490 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004491 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004492
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004493 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4494 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4495 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4496 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4497 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4498 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4499 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004500 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004501
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004502 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004503 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004504 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004505 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004506 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004507 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004508 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004509
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004510 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004511 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4512 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004513 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004514 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004515 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4516 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4517 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4518 "multipart"
4519 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4520 header
4521 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4522 and later
4523 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4524 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004525 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004526
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004527 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004528
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004529 Examples :
4530 compression algo gzip
4531 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004532
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004533 See also : "compression offload"
4534
4535compression offload
4536 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4538 no | yes | yes | yes
4539
4540 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4541 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4542 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4543 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4544 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4545 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4546 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4547 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4548 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4549 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4550 then be used for such scenarios.
4551
4552 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
4553 option is ignored.
4554
4555 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004556
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004557cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004558 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4559 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004560 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4563 yes | no | yes | yes
4564 Arguments :
4565 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4566 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4567 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4568 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4569 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4570 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004571 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004572 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4573 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4574
4575 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004576 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004577 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4578 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4579 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4580 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004581 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4582 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004583 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004584 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4585 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004586
4587 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004588 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004589
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004590 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004591 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004592 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004593 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004594 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4595 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4596 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4597 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4598 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4599 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4600 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004601
4602 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4603 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4604 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4605 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4606 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4607 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4608 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4609 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4610 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004611 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004612 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4613 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4614 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004615
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004616 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4617 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4618 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004619 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4620 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4621 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4622 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004623 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4624 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4625 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004626
4627 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4628 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4629 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4630 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4631 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4632 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4633 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4634 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4635 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4636
4637 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4638 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4639 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4640 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4641 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4642 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4643 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4644 persistence cookie in the cache.
4645 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4646
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004647 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4648 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004649 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004650 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4651 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004652 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004653 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4654 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4655 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4656 they logout.
4657
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004658 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004659 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4660 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4661 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4662
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004663 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004664 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4665 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4666 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4667 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4668 this attribute.
4669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004670 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004671 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004672 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4673 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4674 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4675 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4676 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4677 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004678
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004679 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4680 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4681 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4682 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4683 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4684 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4685 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4686 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004687 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004688 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4689 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4690 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4691 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4692 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4693 the site.
4694
4695 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4696 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4697 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4698 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4699 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4700 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4701 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4702 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4703 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4704 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4705 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4706 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4707 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004708 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004709 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4710 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4711
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004712 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4713 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4714 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4715 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4716 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4717 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4718
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004719 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004720 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4721 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4722 repeated.
4723
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004724 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4725 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4726 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4727 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004728
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004729 Examples :
4730 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4731 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4732 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004733 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004734
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004735 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004736
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004737
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004738declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4739 Declares a capture slot.
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 no | yes | yes | no
4742 Arguments:
4743 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4744
4745 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4746 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4747 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4748 for use in the response.
4749
4750 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004751 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004752 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4753
4754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004755default-server [param*]
4756 Change default options for a server in a backend
4757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | no | yes | yes
4759 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004760 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4761 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4762 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4763 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004764
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004765 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004766 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4767
4768 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004769
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004771default_backend <backend>
4772 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4774 yes | yes | yes | no
4775 Arguments :
4776 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4777
4778 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4779 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4780 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4781 will catch all undetermined requests.
4782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004783 Example :
4784
4785 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4786 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4787 default_backend dynamic
4788
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004789 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004791
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004792description <string>
4793 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4795 no | yes | yes | yes
4796 Arguments : string
4797
4798 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4799 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4800 it describes.
4801 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4802
4803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004804disabled
4805 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | yes | yes | yes
4808 Arguments : none
4809
4810 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4811 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4812 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4813 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4814 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4815 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4816 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4817
4818 See also : "enabled"
4819
4820
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004821dispatch <address>:<port>
4822 Set a default server address
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004825 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004826
4827 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4828 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4829 during start-up.
4830
4831 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4832 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4833 possible with normal servers.
4834
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004835 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004836 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4837 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4838 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4839 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4840
4841 See also : "server"
4842
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004843
4844dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4845 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | no | yes | yes
4848 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4849
4850 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004851 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004852 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4853 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004854 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004855 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004857enabled
4858 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4860 yes | yes | yes | yes
4861 Arguments : none
4862
4863 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4864 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4865
4866 See also : "disabled"
4867
4868
4869errorfile <code> <file>
4870 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4872 yes | yes | yes | yes
4873 Arguments :
4874 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004875 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004876 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004877
4878 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004879 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004880 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004881 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4882 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004883
4884 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4885 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4886 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4887
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004888 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4889
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004890 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4891 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4892 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4893 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4894 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4895 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4896 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4897 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4898 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004900 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4901 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4902 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004903 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004904 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4905
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004906 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004907
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004908 Example :
4909 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004910 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004911 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4912 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4913
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004914
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004915errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4916 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4917 section.
4918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4919 yes | yes | yes | yes
4920 Arguments :
4921 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4922
4923 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004924 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004925 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4926 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004927
4928 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4929 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4930 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4931 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4932 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004933 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004934 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4935
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004936 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4937 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004938
4939 Example :
4940 errorfiles generic
4941 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4942
4943
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004944errorloc <code> <url>
4945errorloc302 <code> <url>
4946 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4948 yes | yes | yes | yes
4949 Arguments :
4950 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004951 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004952 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004953
4954 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4955 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4956 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4957 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004958 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004959
4960 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4961 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4962 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4963
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004964 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4965
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004966 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4967 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4968 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4969 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004970 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004971 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4972 request.
4973
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004974 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004975
4976
4977errorloc303 <code> <url>
4978 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 yes | yes | yes | yes
4981 Arguments :
4982 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004983 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004984 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004985
4986 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4987 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4988 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4989 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004990 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004991
4992 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4993 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4994 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4995
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004996 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4997
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004998 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4999 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5000 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5001 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005002 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005003
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005004 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005005
5006
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005007email-alert from <emailaddr>
5008 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005009 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5011 yes | yes | yes | yes
5012
5013 Arguments :
5014
5015 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5016
5017 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5018 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5019
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005020 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005021 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5022 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005023
5024
5025email-alert level <level>
5026 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5027 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5029 yes | yes | yes | yes
5030
5031 Arguments :
5032
5033 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5034 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5035 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5036
5037 By default level is alert
5038
5039 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5040 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5041 for the proxy.
5042
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005043 Alerts are sent when :
5044
5045 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5046 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5047 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5048 is notice or lower
5049 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5050 and a health check status update occurs
5051
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005052 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5053 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005054 section 3.6 about mailers.
5055
5056
5057email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5058 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5059 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5060 yes | yes | yes | yes
5061
5062 Arguments :
5063
5064 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5065
5066 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5067 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5068
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005069 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5070 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005071
5072
5073email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5074 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5075 mailers.
5076 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5077 yes | yes | yes | yes
5078
5079 Arguments :
5080
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005081 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005082
5083 By default the systems hostname is used.
5084
5085 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5086 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5087 for the proxy.
5088
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005089 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5090 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005091
5092
5093email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005094 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005095 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5096 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5097 yes | yes | yes | yes
5098
5099 Arguments :
5100
5101 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5102
5103 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5104 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5105
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005106 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005107 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5108
5109
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005110error-log-format <string>
5111 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5112 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5113 yes | yes | yes | no
5114
5115 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5116 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5117 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5118 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005119 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5120
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005121 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5122 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5123 string in depth.
5124
5125 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5126 directives.
5127
5128
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005129force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5130 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5131 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005132 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005133
5134 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5135 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5136 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5137 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5138 marked down for maintenance operations.
5139
5140 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5141 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5142 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5143 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5144 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5145 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5146 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5147 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5148 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5149
5150 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5151 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5152 is used.
5153
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005154 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005155 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005156
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005157
5158filter <name> [param*]
5159 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5161 no | yes | yes | yes
5162 Arguments :
5163 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5164 referenced in section 9.
5165
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005166 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005167 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005168 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5169 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005170
5171 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5172 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5173
5174 Example:
5175 listen
5176 bind *:80
5177
5178 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5179 filter compression
5180 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5181
5182 compression algo gzip
5183 compression offload
5184
5185 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5186
5187 See also : section 9.
5188
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005189
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005190fullconn <conns>
5191 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5193 yes | no | yes | yes
5194 Arguments :
5195 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5196 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5197
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005198 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005199 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005200 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005201 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5202 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5203 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5204 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5205 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005206 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005207
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005208 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005209 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005210 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5211 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5212 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005213
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005214 Example :
5215 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5216 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5217 # connections.
5218 backend dynamic
5219 fullconn 10000
5220 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5221 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5222
5223 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5224
5225
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005226hash-balance-factor <factor>
5227 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5229 yes | no | no | yes
5230 Arguments :
5231 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5232 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005233 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005234
5235 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5236 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5237 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5238 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5239 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5240 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5241 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5242
5243 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5244 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5245 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5246 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5247 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5248
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005249 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5250 consistent hashing mechanism.
5251
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005252 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5253
5254
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005255hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005256 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5258 yes | no | yes | yes
5259 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005260 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5261 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005262
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005263 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5264 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5265 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5266 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5267 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5268 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5269 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5270 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5271 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5272 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005273
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005274 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5275 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5276 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5277 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5278 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5279 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5280 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5281 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5282 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5283 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5284 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5285 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5286 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005287 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5288 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005289
5290 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5291
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005292 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005293 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5294 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5295 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005296 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5297 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5298 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005299
5300 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5301 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005302 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5303 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5304 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5305 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5306
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005307 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005308 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5309 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5310 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5311 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5312 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5313 parameter.
5314
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005315 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5316 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5317 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5318 used on strings.
5319
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005320 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5321
5322 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5323 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5324 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5325 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5326 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5327 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5328 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5329 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5330 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5331 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5332 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5333 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005334
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005335 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5336 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5337 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005338
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005339 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005340
5341
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005342http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5343 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5344 ones).
5345
5346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005347 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005348
5349 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5350 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5351 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5352 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5353 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5354 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5355
5356 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5357 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5358 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5359
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005360 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5361 supported:
5362 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5363 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005364 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005365 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5366 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5367 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5368 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5369 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005370 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5371 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005372 - strict-mode { on | off }
5373 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5374
5375 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005376
5377 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5378 instance.
5379
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005380 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5381 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5382 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5383 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5384 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5385 a defaults section defining such rules.
5386
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005387 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5388 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5389 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5390
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005391 Example:
5392 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5393 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5394 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5395
5396http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5397
5398 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005399 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5400 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005401
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005402http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5403
5404 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5405 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5406 complete description.
5407
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005408http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5409
5410 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005411 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005412
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005413http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005414
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005415 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5416 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005417
5418http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5419 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5420
5421 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5422
5423 Example:
5424 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5425
5426 # applied to:
5427 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5428
5429 # outputs:
5430 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5431
5432 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5433
5434http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5435 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5436
5437 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5438
5439 Example:
5440 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5441
5442 # applied to:
5443 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5444
5445 # outputs:
5446 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5447
5448http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5449
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005450 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5451 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5452 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5453 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005454
5455http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5456 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5457
5458 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005459 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005460 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005461
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005462http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5463http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005464
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005465 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5466 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5467 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005468
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005469http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005470
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005471 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5472 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005473
5474http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5475
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005476 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5477 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005478
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005479
5480http-check comment <string>
5481 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5482 it fails.
5483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5484 yes | no | yes | yes
5485
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005486 Arguments :
5487 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5488 rule fails.
5489
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005490 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5491 user-friendly error reporting.
5492
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005493 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005494 "http-check expect".
5495
5496
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005497http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5498 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005499 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005500 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5502 yes | no | yes | yes
5503
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005504 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005505 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5506
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005507 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005508 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005509
5510 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5511 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5512 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5513 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5514
5515 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5516
5517 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5518
5519 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5520
5521 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5522
5523 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5524
5525 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5526 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5527 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5528 is used.
5529
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005530 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5531 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5532 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5533 haproxy -vv.
5534
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005535 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5536
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005537 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5538 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5539 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5540 different ports or with different servers.
5541
5542 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5543 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5544 the port with a "http-check connect".
5545
5546 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5547 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5548 do.
5549
5550 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5551 unset-var or comment rules.
5552
5553 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005554 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5555 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5556 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5557 option httpchk
5558
5559 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005560 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005561 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005562 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005563 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005564 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005565
5566 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5567
5568 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005569
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005570
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005571http-check disable-on-404
5572 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005574 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005575 Arguments : none
5576
5577 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5578 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5579 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5580 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5581 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5582 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5583 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5584 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005585 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5586 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005587 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5588 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5589 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005590
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005591 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005592
5593
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005594http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005595 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5596 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5597 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005598 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005600 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005601
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005602 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005603 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5604
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005605 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5606 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5607 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5608 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5609 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5610 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5611 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5612 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5613 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5614 result is always conclusive.
5615
5616 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5617 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5618 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005619 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5620 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005621 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5622 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005623 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5624 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5625 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005626
5627 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5628 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005629 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5630 supported :
5631 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5632 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005633 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5634 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5635 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5636 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5637 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005638
5639 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5640 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005641 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5642 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5643 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5644 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005645 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5646
5647 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5648 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5649 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5650 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5651
5652 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5653 informational message reported in logs if an error
5654 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5655 log-format string.
5656
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005657 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005658 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5659 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005660 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5661 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5662 details on the supported keywords.
5663
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005664 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5665 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5666 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5667 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005668
5669 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5670 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5671 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5672 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5673 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5674
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005675 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5676 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5677 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5678 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5679 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5680 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5681 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005682
5683 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005684 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5686 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5687 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5688 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5689
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005690 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5691 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005692 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5693 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5694 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5695 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5696 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5697 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5698 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5699 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005700 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5701 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5702 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5703 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5704 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5705 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5706 insensitive on the header names.
5707
5708 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5709 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5710 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5711 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5712 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5713 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005714
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005715 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005716 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005717 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5718 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5719 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5720 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5721 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005722 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005723 trace).
5724
5725 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005726 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005727 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5728 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5729 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5730 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5731 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005732 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005733
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005734 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5735 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5736 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5737 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5738 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5739 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5740
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005741 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005742 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005743 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5744 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5745 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5746 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5747 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5748 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5749
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005750 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5751 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5752 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5753 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5754 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005755
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005756 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5757 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5758
5759 Examples :
5760 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005761 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005762
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005763 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5764 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5765
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005766 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005767 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005768
5769 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005770 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005771
5772 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005773 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005774
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005775 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005776 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005777
5778
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005779http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005780 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5781 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005782 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5783 health checks.
5784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5785 yes | no | yes | yes
5786 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005787 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5788
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005789 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5790 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5791 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5792 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5793 to invent non-standard ones.
5794
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005795 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5796 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5797 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5798 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5799
5800 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5801 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5802 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5803 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005804
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005805 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005806 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005807 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005808 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5809 to add it.
5810
5811 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5812 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5813 to the log-format rules.
5814
5815 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5816 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5817 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005818
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005819 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5820 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5821 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5822 request.
5823
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005824 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5825 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5826 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005827 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5828 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5829 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5830 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005831 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005832
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005833 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005834 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5835 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005836
5837 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5838 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5839 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5840 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5841 configured request authority.
5842
5843 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5844 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005845
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005846 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005847
5848
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005849http-check send-state
5850 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5852 yes | no | yes | yes
5853 Arguments : none
5854
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005855 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005856 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005857 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5858 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5859 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005860
5861 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5862 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5863 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5864 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5865 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005866 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5867 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5868 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5869
5870 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5871 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5872 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5873
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005874 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5875 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5876 checked in multiple backends.
5877
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005878 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005879 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5880
5881 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5882 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5883 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5884 one fails.
5885
5886 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5887 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5888 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5889
5890 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5891 server's queue.
5892
5893 Example of a header received by the application server :
5894 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5895 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5896
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005897 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5898 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005899
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005900
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005901http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5902http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005903 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005904 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5905 yes | no | yes | yes
5906
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005907 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005908 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5909 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5910 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5911 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5912 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5913 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5914 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5915 and '-'.
5916
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005917 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
5918 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05005919 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005920 conditions.
5921
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005922 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5923
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005924 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5925 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5926
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005927 Examples :
5928 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005929 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005930
5931
5932http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005933 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | no | yes | yes
5936
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005937 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005938 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5939 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5940 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5941 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5942 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5943 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5944 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5945 and '-'.
5946
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005947 Examples :
5948 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005951http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5952 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5953 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5954 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5955 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5957 yes | yes | yes | yes
5958 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005959 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005960 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005961 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005962 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005963
5964 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5965 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5966 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5967 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5968
5969 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5970 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5971 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5972 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5973
5974 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5975 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5976 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5977 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5978 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5979 chroot is performed.
5980
5981 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5982 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5983 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5984 considered.
5985
5986 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5987 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5988 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5989 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5990 considered as a raw string.
5991
5992 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5993 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5994 "content-type".
5995
5996 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5997 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5998 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5999 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6000 evaluated as a log-format string.
6001
6002 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6003 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6004 argument to "content-type".
6005
6006 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6007 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6008 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6009 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6010
6011 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6012 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6013 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6014 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6015 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6016 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6017 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6018 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6019
6020 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6021 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6022 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6023
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006024 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6025 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6026 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6027 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6028 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6029
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006030 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6031 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6032
6033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006035 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6036
6037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006038 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006039
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006040 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6041 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6042 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6043 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6044 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006045
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006046 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6047 supported:
6048 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6049 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6050 - allow
6051 - auth [realm <realm>]
6052 - cache-use <name>
6053 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6054 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6055 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6056 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6057 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6058 - disable-l7-retry
6059 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6060 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6061 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6062 - redirect <rule>
6063 - reject
6064 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6065 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6066 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6067 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6068 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6069 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6070 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6071 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6072 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6073 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6074 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6075 - set-dst <expr>
6076 - set-dst-port <expr>
6077 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6078 - set-log-level <level>
6079 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6080 - set-mark <mark>
6081 - set-method <fmt>
6082 - set-nice <nice>
6083 - set-path <fmt>
6084 - set-pathq <fmt>
6085 - set-priority-class <expr>
6086 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6087 - set-query <fmt>
6088 - set-src <expr>
6089 - set-src-port <expr>
6090 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6091 - set-tos <tos>
6092 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006093 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6094 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006095 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6096 - silent-drop
6097 - strict-mode { on | off }
6098 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6099 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6100 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6101 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6102 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6103 - use-service <service-name>
6104 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6105 - wait-for-handshake
6106 - cache-use <name>
6107
6108 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006111
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006112 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6113 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6114 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6115 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6116 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6117 a defaults section defining such rules.
6118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006119 Example:
6120 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6121 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6122 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124 http-request allow if nagios
6125 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6126 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6127 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006129 Example:
6130 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6131 acl add path /addacl
6132 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006134 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006135
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006136 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6137 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006139 Example:
6140 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6141 acl setmap path /setmap
6142 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006144 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006146 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6147 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006149 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6150 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006152http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006154 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6155 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6156 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6157 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6158 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6159 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6160 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6161 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006163http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006165 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6166 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6167 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6168 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6169 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6170 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6171 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6172 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006174http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006176 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006177 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006179http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006181 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6182 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6183 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6184 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6185 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006186
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006187 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6188 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6189 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6190 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6191 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6192 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6193 instead.
6194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006195 Example:
6196 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6197 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006198
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006199http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006200
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006201 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006203http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6204 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006206 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6207 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6208 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6209 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6210 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6211 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6212 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6213 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6214 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006216 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6217 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6218 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006219 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6220
6221 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6222 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6223 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6224 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006226http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006228 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6229 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6230 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6231 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6232 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6233 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006234
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006235http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006236
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006237 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6238 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6239 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6240 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6241 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006243http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006245 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6246 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6247 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6248 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6249 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6250 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006251
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006252http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6253http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6254 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6255 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6256 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6257 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006258
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006259 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6260 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6261 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006262 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006263 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6264 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6265 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006266 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006267 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006268
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006269http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6270 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6271 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6272 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6273
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006274http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6275 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006276
6277 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6278 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6279 pointed by <resolvers>.
6280 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6281 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6282 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6283 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6284 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6285 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6286 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6287 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6288 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6289 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6290 to 0.0.0.0.
6291
6292 Example:
6293 resolvers mydns
6294 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6295 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6296 timeout retry 1s
6297 hold valid 10s
6298 hold nx 3s
6299 hold other 3s
6300 hold obsolete 0s
6301 accepted_payload_size 8192
6302
6303 frontend fe
6304 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6305 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6306 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6307
6308 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6309 # which mean DNS resolution error
6310 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6311
6312 default_backend be
6313
6314 backend b_503
6315 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6316 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6317 # 503 error page to end users
6318
6319 backend be
6320 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6321 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6322 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6323 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6324 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6325
6326 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6327 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6328
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006329http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6330
6331 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6332 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6333 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6334 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006335 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6336 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006337
6338 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6339
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006340http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006341http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006342http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006343http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006344http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006345http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006346http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006347http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6348http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006349
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006350 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6351
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006352 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006353 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6354 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6355 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6356 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006357
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006358 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6359 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6360 the supported backend.
6361
6362 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6363 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6364 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6365 number of segments in the path.
6366
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006367 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6368 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6369 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6370 when improperly combined.
6371
6372 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6373 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6374 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6375 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6376 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6377
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006378 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006379
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006380 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6381
6382 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6383 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6384
6385 Example:
6386 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6387
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006388 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6389
6390 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6391 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6392
6393 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6394 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6395
6396 Example:
6397 - /#foo -> /
6398
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006399 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6400 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006401
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006402 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6403 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6404
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006405 Example:
6406 - /. -> /
6407 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6408 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6409 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006410
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006411 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6412 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6413
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006414 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006415 their preceding segment.
6416
6417 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6418 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6419
6420 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6421 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006422
6423 Example:
6424 - /foo/../ -> /
6425 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6426 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6427 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006428 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006429 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006430 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006431
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006432 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6433 removed as well:
6434
6435 Example:
6436 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6437 - /bar/../../ -> /
6438
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006439 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6440 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006441
6442 Example:
6443 - // -> /
6444 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6445
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006446 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6447 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6448
6449 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6450 ".", "_", and "~".
6451
6452 Example:
6453 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6454 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6455 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6456 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6457
6458 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6459 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6460
6461 Example:
6462 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6463 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6464
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006465 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006466 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006467
6468 Example:
6469 - /%6f -> /%6F
6470 - /%zz -> /%zz
6471
6472 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6473 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6474
6475 Example:
6476 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6477
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006478 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006479 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6480 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6481
6482 Example:
6483 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6484 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6485 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006487http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006489 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6490 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6491 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6492 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6493 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006495http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006497 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6498 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6499 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6500 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006502http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6503 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006504
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006505 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006506 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6507 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6508 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6509 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6510 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006511
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006512 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6513 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6514 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6515 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6516 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006517
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006518 Example:
6519 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6520
6521 # applied to:
6522 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6523
6524 # outputs:
6525 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6526
6527 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006528
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006529 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6530
6531 # applied to:
6532 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006533
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006534 # outputs:
6535 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006536
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006537http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6538 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6539
6540 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6541 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006542 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6543 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6544 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006545
6546 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6547 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6548 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6549
6550 Example:
6551 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6552 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6553
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006554 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6555 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6556 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6557 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6558
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006559http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6560 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6561
6562 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6563 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6564 query-string are replaced.
6565
6566 Example:
6567 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6568 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6569
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006570http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6571 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6572
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006573 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6574 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6575 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6576 against.
6577
6578 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6579 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6580 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006581
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006582 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6583 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6584 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6585 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6586 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6587 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6588 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6589 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6590 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006591 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6592 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006593
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006594 Example:
6595 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6596 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006597
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006598 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6599 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006601http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6602 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006603
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006604 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6605 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6606 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6607 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006608
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006609 Example:
6610 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006611
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006612 # applied to:
6613 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006614
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006615 # outputs:
6616 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006617
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006618http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6619 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6620 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006621 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006622 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6623
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006624 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006625 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6626 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006627 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006628 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006629 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006630 are followed to create the response :
6631
6632 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6633 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6634 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6635 ignored.
6636
6637 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6638 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006639 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006640 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6641 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006642
6643 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6644 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6645 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006646 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006647 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006648
6649 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6650 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6651 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006652 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006653 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006654 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006655
6656 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6657 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6658 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6659 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6660 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6661 as a raw content.
6662
6663 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6664 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6665 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6666 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6667 considered as a raw string.
6668
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006669 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006670 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6671 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6672 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6673
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006674 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6675 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006676 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006677
6678 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6679
6680 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006681 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006682 if { path /ping }
6683
6684 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6685 if { path /favicon.ico }
6686
6687 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6688 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6689 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6690
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006691http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6692
6693 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6694 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6695 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6696 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6697 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6698 at this index.
6699 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6700 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006702http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6703http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6706 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6707 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006708
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006709http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6710 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6711 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6712 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6713 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6714 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6715 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6716 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6717 at this index.
6718 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6719 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6720
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006721http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6722 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006723
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006724 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6725 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6726 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6727 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006728
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006729http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6730 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6731
6732 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6733 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6734 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6735 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6736 agent name must be used.
6737
6738 Arguments:
6739 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6740
6741 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6742 configuration.
6743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006744http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006746 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6747 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6748 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6749 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6750 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006751
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006752 Arguments:
6753 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6754 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006756 Example:
6757 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6758 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006760 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6761 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006763http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006765 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6766 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6767 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769 Arguments:
6770 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6771 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006773 Example:
6774 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6775 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006777 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6778 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6779 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006781http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006782
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006783 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6784 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6785 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6786 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6787 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006788
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006789 Example:
6790 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6791 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6792 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6793 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6794 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6795 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6796 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6797 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6798 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006800http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006802 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6803 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6804 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6805 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6806 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006808http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6809 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006811 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6812 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6813 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6814 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6815 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6816 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6817 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6818 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6819 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006821http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006822
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006823 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6824 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6825 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6826 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6827 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6828 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6829 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006830 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6831 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006832
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006833http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006834
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006835 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6836 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6837 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006839http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006840
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006841 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6842 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6843 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6844 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6845 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6846 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6847 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6848 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006850http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006852 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6853 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6854 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6855 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6856 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6857 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006859 Example :
6860 # prepend the host name before the path
6861 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006862
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006863http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6864
6865 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6866 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6867 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006869http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006870
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006871 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6872 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6873 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6874 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6875 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006876
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006877http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006879 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6880 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6881 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6882 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6883 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6884 values have higher priority.
6885 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6886 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6887 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6888 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6889 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006891http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006893 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6894 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6895 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6896 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6897 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6898 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6899 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006901 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006902
6903 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006904 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6905 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006906
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006907http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6908 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6909 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6910 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006911 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6912 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006913
6914 Arguments :
6915 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6916 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006917
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006918 See also "option forwardfor".
6919
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006920 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006921 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6922 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6923
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006924 # After the masking this will track connections
6925 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6926 http-request track-sc0 src
6927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006928 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6929 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6930
6931http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6932
6933 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6934 expression.
6935
6936 Arguments:
6937 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6938 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006939
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006940 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006941 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6942 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6943
6944 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6945 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6946 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6947
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006948http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006949 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6950
6951 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6952 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6953 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6954 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6955 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6956
6957 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6958 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6959 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6960 results.
6961
6962 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006963 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6964 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006965
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006966http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6967
6968 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6969 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6970 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6971 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6972 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6973 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6974 information from the request.
6975
6976 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6977
6978http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6979
6980 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6981 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6982 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6983 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6984 path and the query string.
6985 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6986
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006987http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6988http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006989
6990 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6991 inline.
6992
6993 Arguments:
6994 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6995 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6996 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6997 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6998 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6999 (request and response)
7000 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7001 processing
7002 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7003 processing
7004 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7005 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7006 and '_'.
7007
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007008 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7009 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007010 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007011 conditions.
7012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007013 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7014 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007015
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007016 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7017 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7018
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007019 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007020 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007021 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007023http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7024
7025 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7026 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7027 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7028 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7029 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7030 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7031 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7032 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7033 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7034 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7035 action.
7036 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7037 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7038 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7039 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7040 you fully understand how it works.
7041
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007042http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007043
7044 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7045 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7046 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7047 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7048 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007049 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007050 processing.
7051
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007052 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007053 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7054 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7055 rules evaluation.
7056
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007057http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7058http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7059 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7060 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7061 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7062 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007063
7064 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7065 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7066 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007067 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7068 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7069 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7070 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7071 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7072 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007073 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007074 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7075 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7076 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007077 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007078 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7079 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7080 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7081 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7082 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007083
7084http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7085http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7086http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7087
7088 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7089 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7090 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7091 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007092 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007093 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7094 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7095 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7096 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7097 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7098 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7099 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7100
7101 Arguments :
7102 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7103 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7104 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7105 select which table entry to update the counters.
7106
7107 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7108 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7109 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7110 that table until the session ends.
7111
7112 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7113 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7114 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7115 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7116 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7117 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7118 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7119 useful information.
7120
7121 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7122 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7123 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7124 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7125 checks that make use of it.
7126
7127http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7128
7129 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007130
7131 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007132 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007133
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007134http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7135
7136 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7137 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7138 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7139 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7140 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7141 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7142
7143 Arguments :
7144 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7145
7146 Example:
7147 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7148
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007149http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7150 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7151
7152 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7153 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7154 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7155 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7156 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7157 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7158 http-buffer-request".
7159
7160 Arguments :
7161
7162 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7163 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7164
7165 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007166 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007167 bytes.
7168
7169 Example:
7170 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7171
7172 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007174http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007176 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7177 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7178 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007179
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007181http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007182 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7183
7184 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007185 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007186
7187 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7188 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7189 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7190 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7191 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7192 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7193
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007194 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7195 supported:
7196 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7197 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7198 - allow
7199 - cache-store <name>
7200 - capture <sample> id <id>
7201 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7202 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7203 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7204 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7205 - redirect <rule>
7206 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7207 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7208 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7209 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7210 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7211 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7212 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7213 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7214 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7215 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7216 - set-log-level <level>
7217 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7218 - set-mark <mark>
7219 - set-nice <nice>
7220 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7221 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007222 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7223 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007224 - silent-drop
7225 - strict-mode { on | off }
7226 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7227 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7228 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7229 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7230 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7231
7232 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007233
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007234 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007235
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007236 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7237 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7238 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7239 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7240 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7241 a defaults section defining such rules.
7242
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007243 Example:
7244 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007246 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007248 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7249 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007250
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007251 Example:
7252 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007253
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007254 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007255
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007256 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7257 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007258
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007259 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7260 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007261
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007262http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007263
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007264 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7265 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007266
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007267http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007269 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007270 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7271 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007272
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007273http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007274
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007275 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7276 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007277
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007278http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007279
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007280 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007281
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007282http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007284 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7285 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7286 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7287 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7288 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7289 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7290 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007291
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007292 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7293 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7294 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7295 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7296 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007297
7298 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7299 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7300 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7301 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007303http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007304
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007305 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7306 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007307
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007308http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007309
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007310 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7311 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007312
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007313http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007314
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007315 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7316 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007317
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007318http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7319http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7320 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7321 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7322 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7323 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007324
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007325 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7326 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7327 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007328 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007329 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7330 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7331 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007332 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007333 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007334
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007335http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007336
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007337 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7338 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7339 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7340 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7341 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7342 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007343
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007344http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7345 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007346
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007347 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7348 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007349
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007350 Example:
7351 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007352
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007353 # applied to:
7354 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007355
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007356 # outputs:
7357 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007358
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007359 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007360
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007361http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7362 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007363
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007364 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007365 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007366
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007367 Example:
7368 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007369
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007370 # applied to:
7371 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007372
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007373 # outputs:
7374 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007375
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007376http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7377 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7378 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007379 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007380 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7381
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007382 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7383 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7384 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007385
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007386http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007387http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7388http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007389
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007390 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7391 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7392 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7393 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007394
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007395http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007396 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007397http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007399http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7400 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007401
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007402 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7403 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7404 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007405
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007406http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7407 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007408
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007409 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7410 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007412http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007413
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007414 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7415 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7416 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7417 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007418
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007419http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7420
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007421 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7422 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007423
7424http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7425
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007426 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7427 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007428
7429http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7430
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007431 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7432 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7433 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007434
7435http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7436
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007437 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7438 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007439
7440http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7441 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7442
7443 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7444 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7445 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7446 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007447
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007448 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007449 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7450 http-response set-status 431
7451 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7452 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007453
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007454http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007455
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007456 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007457 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7458 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007459
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007460http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7461http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007462
7463 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007464 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7465 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007466
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007467http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007468
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007469 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7470 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007471 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7472 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007473
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007474http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007475
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007476 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7477 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007479http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7480http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7481http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007482
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007483 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7484 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7485 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007486
7487http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7488
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007489 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007490 about <var-name>.
7491
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007492http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7493 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7494
7495 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007496 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7497 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007498
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007499
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007500http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7501 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7502
7503 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7504 yes | no | yes | yes
7505
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007506 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007507 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7508 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7509 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007510
7511 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7512
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007513 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7514 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7515 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7516 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7517 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7518 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7519 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007520 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007521 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7522 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007523
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007524 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7525 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7526 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7527 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7528 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7529 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7530 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007531 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7532 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7533 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7534 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7535 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7536 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007537
7538 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7539 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7540 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7541 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7542 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7543 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7544 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7545 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007546 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007547 downsides of rare connection failures.
7548
7549 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7550 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7551 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7552 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7553 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7554 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007555 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007556 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7557 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7558 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7559 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7560 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7561
7562 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007563 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7564 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7565 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7566 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007567
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007568 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7569 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007570
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007571 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007572
7573 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7574 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7575 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7576
7577 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7578
7579
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007580http-send-name-header [<header>]
7581 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7583 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007584 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007585 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7586
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007587 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7588 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7589 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7590 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7591 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7592 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7593 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7594 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7595 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7596 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7597 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7598 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7599 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7600 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7601 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7602 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007603
7604 See also : "server"
7605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007606id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007607 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7609 no | yes | yes | yes
7610 Arguments : none
7611
7612 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7613 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7614 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007615
7616
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007617ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7618 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007620 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007621
7622 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7623 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7624 and running).
7625
7626 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7627 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7628 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007629 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007630 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7631
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007632 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7633 "unless" condition is met.
7634
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007635 Example:
7636 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7637 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7638 ignore-persist if url_static
7639
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007640 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7641
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007642load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7643 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7645 yes | no | yes | yes
7646
7647 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7648 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7649 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007650 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007651 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007652 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7653 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7654 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7655
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007656 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007657 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007658 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007659
7660 Arguments:
7661 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7662 named "server-state-file".
7663
7664 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7665 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7666 name is used as a file name.
7667
7668 none don't load any stat for this backend
7669
7670 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007671 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7672 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7673 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007674 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007675 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007676
7677 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7678 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7679
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007680 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007681
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007682 global
7683 stats socket /tmp/socket
7684 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007685
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007686 defaults
7687 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007688
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007689 backend bk
7690 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7691 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007692
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007693
7694 Then one can run :
7695
7696 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7697
7698 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7699
7700 1
7701 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7702 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7703 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7704
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007705 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007706
7707 global
7708 stats socket /tmp/socket
7709 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7710
7711 defaults
7712 load-server-state-from-file local
7713
7714 backend bk
7715 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7716 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7717
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007718
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007719 Then one can run :
7720
7721 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7722
7723 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7724
7725 1
7726 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7727 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7728 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7729
7730 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7731 "show servers state"
7732
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007733
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007734log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007735log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007736 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007737no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007738 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7740 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007741
7742 Prefix :
7743 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7744 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7745 prefix does not allow arguments.
7746
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007747 Arguments :
7748 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7749 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7750 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7751 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7752 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7753 parameter.
7754
7755 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7756 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7757
7758 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7759 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7760 standard syslog port).
7761
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007762 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7763 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7764 standard syslog port).
7765
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007766 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7767 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7768 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007769 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007770
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007771 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7772 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7773 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7774 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7775 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7776 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7777 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7778 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7779 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7780 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7781 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7782 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007783 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007784 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7785 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7786 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007787 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7788 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007789
7790 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7791 and "fd@2", see above.
7792
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007793 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7794 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7795 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7796 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7797 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7798 having the logs instantly available.
7799
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007800 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7801 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7802 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7803
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007804 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7805 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007806
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007807 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7808 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7809 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7810 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7811 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7812 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7813 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7814 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7815 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7816 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007817 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007818
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007819 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7820 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7821 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7822 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7823 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7824
7825 <sample_size>
7826 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7827 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7828 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7829 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7830 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7831
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007832 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7833 one of the following :
7834
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007835 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7836 field is stripped. This is the default.
7837 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7838 rfc3164.
7839
7840 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007841 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7842
7843 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7844 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7845
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007846 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7847 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7848 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7849 designed to be used with a local log server.
7850
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007851 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7852 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7853 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7854 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7855 systemd logger consumes.
7856
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007857 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7858 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7859 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7860 used with a local log server.
7861
7862 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7863 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7864 designed to be used with a local log server.
7865
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007866 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7867 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7868 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7869 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7870
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007871 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7872
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007873 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7874 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7875 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7876
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007877 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7878 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7879 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7880 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007881
7882 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7883 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7884 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007885 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7886 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7887 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7888 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7889 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007890
7891 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7892
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007893 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7894 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7895 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007896
7897 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7898 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7899 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7900 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7901
7902 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7903 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007904
7905 Example :
7906 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007907 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7908 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7909 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007910 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007911 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7912 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007913 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007914
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007915
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007916log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007917 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7918 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7919 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007920
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007921 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7922 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7923 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7924 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7925 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02007926 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
7927 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007928
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007929 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7930 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007931
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007932log-format-sd <string>
7933 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 yes | yes | yes | no
7936
7937 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7938 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7939 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7940 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7941 which covers the log format string in depth.
7942
7943 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7944 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7945
7946 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7947 log format to "rfc5424".
7948
7949 Example :
7950 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7951
7952
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007953log-tag <string>
7954 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7955 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7956 yes | yes | yes | yes
7957
7958 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7959 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007960 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007961 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7962 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7963 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7964 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7965 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7966 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007967
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007968max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7969 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7970 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7971 yes | no | yes | yes
7972
7973 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7974 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7975 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7976 servers.
7977
7978 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007979 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007980 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7981 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7982 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007983 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007984 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7985 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7986 picking a different server.
7987
7988 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7989 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7990 even if they have to be queued.
7991
7992 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7993 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7994
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007995max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7996 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7997 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7998 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007999
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008000maxconn <conns>
8001 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8003 yes | yes | yes | no
8004 Arguments :
8005 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8006 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8007 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8008 closes.
8009
8010 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008011 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008012 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8013 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008014 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8015 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8016 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8017 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008018
8019 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8020 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8021 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8022
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008023 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8024 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008025
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008026 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8027
8028
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008029mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008030 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8032 yes | yes | yes | yes
8033 Arguments :
8034 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8035 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8036 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8037 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8038
8039 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8040 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8041 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8042 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8043 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8044
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008045 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8046 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8047 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008048
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008049 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008050 defaults http_instances
8051 mode http
8052
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008053
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008054monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008055 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8057 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008058 Arguments :
8059 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8060 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008061 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008062 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8063 backend and its backup.
8064
8065 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8066 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8067 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8068 servers in a list of backends.
8069
8070 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8071 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8072 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008073 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008074 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8075 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008076 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008077 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8078 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008079
8080 Example:
8081 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008082 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008083 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8084 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8085 monitor-uri /site_alive
8086 monitor fail if site_dead
8087
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008088 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008089
8090
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008091monitor-uri <uri>
8092 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8094 yes | yes | yes | no
8095 Arguments :
8096 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8097 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8098
8099 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8100 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8101 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8102 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8103 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8104 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8105 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8106 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8107
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008108 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008109 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8110 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8111 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8112 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8113 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8114 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008115
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008116 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8117 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8118 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8119 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8120
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008121 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008122 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008123 frontend www
8124 mode http
8125 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8126
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008127 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008129
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008130option abortonclose
8131no option abortonclose
8132 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8134 yes | no | yes | yes
8135 Arguments : none
8136
8137 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8138 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8139 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8140 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008141 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008142 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8143 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8144 encountered while delivering the response.
8145
8146 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8147 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8148 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8149 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8150 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8151 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008152 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008153 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008154 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008155 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8156 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8157 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8158
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008159 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8160 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008161 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8162 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8163 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8164 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8165 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8166 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008167 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008168
8169 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8170 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8171
8172 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8173
8174
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008175option accept-invalid-http-request
8176no option accept-invalid-http-request
8177 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8179 yes | yes | yes | no
8180 Arguments : none
8181
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008182 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008183 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008184 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008185 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8186 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8187 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8188 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8189 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008190 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8191 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8192 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8193 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008194 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008195 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008196 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8197 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8198 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008199
8200 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8201 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8202 been confirmed.
8203
8204 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8205 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008206 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8207 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008208 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8209
8210 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8211 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8212
8213 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8214 stats socket.
8215
8216
8217option accept-invalid-http-response
8218no option accept-invalid-http-response
8219 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8221 yes | no | yes | yes
8222 Arguments : none
8223
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008224 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008225 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008226 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008227 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8228 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8229 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8230 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8231 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008232 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8233 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8234 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008235
8236 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8237 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8238 been confirmed.
8239
8240 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8241 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8242 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8243 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8244
8245 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8246 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8247
8248 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8249 stats socket.
8250
8251
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008252option allbackups
8253no option allbackups
8254 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8256 yes | no | yes | yes
8257 Arguments : none
8258
8259 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8260 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8261 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8262 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8263 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8264 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8265 order between the backup servers anymore.
8266
8267 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8268 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8269
8270 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8271 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8272
8273
8274option checkcache
8275no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008276 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8278 yes | no | yes | yes
8279 Arguments : none
8280
8281 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8282 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008283 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008284 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8285 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008286 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008287
8288 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008289 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008290 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008291 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8292 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008293 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008294 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008295 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8296 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008297 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008298 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8299 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008300 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008301 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8302 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8303 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8304 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8305 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8306 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8307 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8308 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8309 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8310
8311 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008312 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8313 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8314 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8315 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008316
8317 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8318 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008319 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008320 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008321
8322 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8323 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8324
8325
8326option clitcpka
8327no option clitcpka
8328 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8330 yes | yes | yes | no
8331 Arguments : none
8332
8333 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8334 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008335 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008336 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8337
8338 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8339 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8340 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8341 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8342
8343 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8344 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8345 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8346 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8347 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8348
8349 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8350
8351 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8352 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8353 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8354
8355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8357
8358 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8359
8360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008361option contstats
8362 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8364 yes | yes | yes | no
8365 Arguments : none
8366
8367 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8368 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8369 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008370 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008371 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8372 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8373 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8374 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8375 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008376
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008377option disable-h2-upgrade
8378no option disable-h2-upgrade
8379 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8380 connection.
8381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8382 yes | yes | yes | no
8383 Arguments : none
8384
8385 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8386 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8387 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8388 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008389 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8390 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8391 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8392 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8393 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8394 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008395
8396 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8397 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008398
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008399option dontlog-normal
8400no option dontlog-normal
8401 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8403 yes | yes | yes | no
8404 Arguments : none
8405
8406 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8407 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8408 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8409 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8410 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8411 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8412 logged.
8413
8414 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8415 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8416 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008418 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008419 logging.
8420
8421
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008422option dontlognull
8423no option dontlognull
8424 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8426 yes | yes | yes | no
8427 Arguments : none
8428
8429 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8430 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8431 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8432 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8433 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8434 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008435 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8436 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8437 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008438
8439 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008440 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008441 would not be logged.
8442
8443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8445
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008446 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008447 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008448
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008449
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008450option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008451 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8453 yes | yes | yes | yes
8454 Arguments :
8455 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8456 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008457 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008458 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008459
8460 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8461 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8462 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8463 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8464 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8465 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8466 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008467 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8468 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8469 possible that the client has already brought one.
8470
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008471 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008472 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008473 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008474 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008475 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008476 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008477
8478 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8479 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8480 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8481 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8482 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8483 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008484 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008485
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008486 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8487 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008488 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008489 are under the control of the end-user.
8490
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008491 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008492 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8493 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008494 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8495 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8496 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008497
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008498 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008499 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8500 frontend www
8501 mode http
8502 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8503
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008504 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8505 backend www
8506 mode http
8507 option forwardfor header X-Client
8508
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008509 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008510 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008511
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008512
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008513option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8514no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8515 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8517 yes | yes | yes | no
8518 Arguments : none
8519
8520 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8521 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8522 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8523 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8524 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8525 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8526 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8527
8528 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8529 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8530 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8531 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8532 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8533 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8534 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8535 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8536 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8537 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8538
8539 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8540
8541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8543
8544 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8545 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8546
8547
8548option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8549no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8550 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8552 yes | no | yes | yes
8553 Arguments : none
8554
8555 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8556 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8557 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8558 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8559 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8560 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8561 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8562
8563 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8564 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8565 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8566 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8567 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8568 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8569 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8570 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8571 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8572 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8573
8574 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8575
8576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8578
8579 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8580 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8581
8582
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008583option http-buffer-request
8584no option http-buffer-request
8585 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8587 yes | yes | yes | yes
8588 Arguments : none
8589
8590 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8591 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8592 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8593 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8594 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8595 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008596 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8597 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8598 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8599 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008600
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008601 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8602 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008603
8604
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008605option http-ignore-probes
8606no option http-ignore-probes
8607 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8609 yes | yes | yes | no
8610 Arguments : none
8611
8612 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8613 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8614 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8615 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8616 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8617 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8618 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8619 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8620 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008621 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8622 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008623 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8624
8625 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8626 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8627 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8628 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8629 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8630 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8631 are often the only way to detect them.
8632
8633 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8634 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8635
8636 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8637
8638
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008639option http-keep-alive
8640no option http-keep-alive
8641 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8643 yes | yes | yes | yes
8644 Arguments : none
8645
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008646 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8647 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008648 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8649 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008650 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8651 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8652 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008653
8654 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8655 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008656 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8657 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8658 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8659 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8660 situations where this option may be useful :
8661
8662 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008663 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008664
8665 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8666 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8667
8668 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8669 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8670 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8671 request.
8672
8673 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8674 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008675 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8676 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8677 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008678
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008679 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8680 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8681 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8682 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8683 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8684 not set.
8685
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008686 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8687 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8688 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008689
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008690 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008691 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008692 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008693
8694
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008695option http-no-delay
8696no option http-no-delay
8697 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8699 yes | yes | yes | yes
8700 Arguments : none
8701
8702 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8703 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8704 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8705 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8706 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8707 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8708 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008709 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008710 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8711 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8712 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8713 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8714 affected.
8715
8716 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8717 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8718 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8719 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8720 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8721 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8722 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8723 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8724 latency environments.
8725
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008726 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8727
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008728
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008729option http-pretend-keepalive
8730no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008731 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008733 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008734 Arguments : none
8735
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008736 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008737 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8738 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8739 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008740 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008741 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8742 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8743 consider the response complete.
8744
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008745 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008746 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008747 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008748 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008749 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008750 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8751
8752 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8753 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8754 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8755 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008756 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8757 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008758 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8759
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008760 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8761 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8762 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8763 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8764 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8765 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008766
8767 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8768 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8769
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008770 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008771 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008772
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008773
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008774option http-server-close
8775no option http-server-close
8776 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8778 yes | yes | yes | yes
8779 Arguments : none
8780
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008781 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8782 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8783 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8784 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008785 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8786 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8787 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8788 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8789 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8790 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8791 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8792 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8793 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8794 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8795 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008796
8797 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8798 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8799 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8800 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008801 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8802 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008803
8804 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8805 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008806 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8807 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8808 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008809
8810 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8811 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8812
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008813 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8814 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008815
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008816option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008817no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008818 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8820 yes | yes | yes | no
8821 Arguments : none
8822
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008823 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008824 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8825 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8826 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8827 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8828 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008829 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008830
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008831 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008832 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008833 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8834 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8835 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008836
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008837 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8838 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8839 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8840 front of an existing proxy.
8841
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008842 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8843
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008844 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008845
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008846option httpchk
8847option httpchk <uri>
8848option httpchk <method> <uri>
8849option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008850 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8852 yes | no | yes | yes
8853 Arguments :
8854 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8855 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8856 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8857 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8858 ones.
8859
8860 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8861 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8862 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8863
8864 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8865 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8866 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008867 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008868
8869 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8870 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8871 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8872 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8873 the lack of any response.
8874
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008875 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8876 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8877 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8878 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8879
8880 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8881 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8882 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008883
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008884 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8885 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008886 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008887 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008888 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008889
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008890 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8891 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8892 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8893 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8894
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008895 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008896 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8897 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8898 backend https_relay
8899 mode tcp
8900 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8901 http-check send hdr Host www
8902 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008903
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008904 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8905 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8906 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008907
8908
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008909option httpclose
8910no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008911 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8913 yes | yes | yes | yes
8914 Arguments : none
8915
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008916 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8917 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8918 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8919 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008920 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008921
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008922 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8923 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008924 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008925 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8926 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008927
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008928 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8929 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8930 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008931
8932 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8933 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008934 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8935 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8936 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008937
8938 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8939 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8940
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008941 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008942
8943
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008944option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008945 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008947 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008948 Arguments :
8949 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8950 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8951 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008952 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008953 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008954
8955 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8956 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8957 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8958 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8959 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8960 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8961 ports.
8962
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008963 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8964 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008965
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008966 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008968 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008969
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008970option httpslog
8971 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8973 yes | yes | yes | no
8974
8975 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8976 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8977 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8978 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8979 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8980 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8981 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8982
8983 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8984
8985 See also : section 8 about logging.
8986
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008987
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008988option independent-streams
8989no option independent-streams
8990 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8992 yes | yes | yes | yes
8993 Arguments : none
8994
8995 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8996 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8997 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8998 receive data or not.
8999
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009000 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009001 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9002 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9003 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9004 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9005 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9006 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9007 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9008 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9009 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9010 socket buffers.
9011
9012 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9013 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9014 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9015 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9016 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9017
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009018 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009019
9020
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009021option ldap-check
9022 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9024 yes | no | yes | yes
9025 Arguments : none
9026
9027 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9028 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9029 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9030 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9031
9032 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9033 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9034
9035 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9036 configure it.
9037
9038 Example :
9039 option ldap-check
9040
9041 See also : "option httpchk"
9042
9043
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009044option external-check
9045 Use external processes for server health checks
9046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9047 yes | no | yes | yes
9048
9049 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9050 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9051 command".
9052
9053 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9054
9055 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9056
9057
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009058option idle-close-on-response
9059no option idle-close-on-response
9060 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9062 yes | yes | yes | no
9063 Arguments : none
9064
9065 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9066 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9067 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9068 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9069 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9070 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9071 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9072 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9073 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9074
9075 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9076 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9077
9078 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9079 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9080 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9081 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9082
9083 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9084 "hard-stop-after"
9085
9086
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009087option log-health-checks
9088no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009089 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9091 yes | no | yes | yes
9092 Arguments : none
9093
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009094 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9095 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9096 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009097
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009098 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9099 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9100 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9101 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9102 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9103
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009104 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009105 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009106
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009107 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9108 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9109 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009110
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009111
9112option log-separate-errors
9113no option log-separate-errors
9114 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9116 yes | yes | yes | no
9117 Arguments : none
9118
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009119 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009120 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9121 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9122 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9123 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9124 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9125 provides very important information.
9126
9127 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9128 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9129 error logs.
9130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009131 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009132 logging.
9133
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009134
9135option logasap
9136no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009137 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9139 yes | yes | yes | no
9140 Arguments : none
9141
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009142 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9143 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9144 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9145 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9146
9147 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9148 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9149 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9150 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9151 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009152 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009153 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9154 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9155 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9156 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009157 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009158
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009159 Examples :
9160 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9161 mode http
9162 option httplog
9163 option logasap
9164 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9165
9166 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9167 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9168 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9169 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009171 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009172 logging.
9173
9174
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009175option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009176 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9178 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009179 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009180 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9181 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009182 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9183 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009184
9185 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9186 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009187 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009188 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009189 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9190 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9191 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009192
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009193 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9194 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9195 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009196
9197 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009198 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009199 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9200 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9201 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9202 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9203 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9204 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9205 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9206
9207 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9208 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009209
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009210 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009211
9212 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9213 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9214 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9215 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009216 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009217 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009218
9219 See also: "option httpchk"
9220
9221
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009222option nolinger
9223no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009224 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9226 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009227 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009228
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009229 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009230 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9231 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9232 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9233 connections.
9234
9235 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9236 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009237 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9238 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9239 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9240 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9241 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9242 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9243 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9244 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9245 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9246 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9247 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9248 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9249 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009250
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009251 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9252 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9253 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9254 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9255 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009256
9257 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9258 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009259 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009260 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009261 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009262
9263 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9264 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9265
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009266 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9267 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009268
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009269option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9270 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9272 yes | yes | yes | yes
9273 Arguments :
9274 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9275 matching <network>
9276 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9277 header name.
9278
9279 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9280 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9281 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9282 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9283 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9284 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9285 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9286 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9287 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9288 possible that the client has already brought one.
9289
9290 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9291 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9292 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9293 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9294 header and requires different one.
9295
9296 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9297 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9298 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009299 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9300 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9301 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9302 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9303 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009304
9305 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9306 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9307 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9308 both are defined.
9309
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009310 Examples :
9311 # Original Destination address
9312 frontend www
9313 mode http
9314 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9315
9316 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9317 backend www
9318 mode http
9319 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9320
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009321 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009322
9323
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009324option persist
9325no option persist
9326 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9327 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9328 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009329 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009330
9331 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9332 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9333 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9334 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9335 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9336 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9337 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9338 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9339 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9340 redirected to another valid server.
9341
9342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9344
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009345 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009346
9347
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009348option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9349 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9351 yes | no | yes | yes
9352 Arguments :
9353 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9354 PostgreSQL server.
9355
9356 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9357 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9358 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9359 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9360
9361 See also: "option httpchk"
9362
9363
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009364option prefer-last-server
9365no option prefer-last-server
9366 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9367 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9368 yes | no | yes | yes
9369 Arguments : none
9370
9371 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009372 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009373 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9374 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009375 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009376 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009377 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009378 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9379 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009380 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009381 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009382 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9383 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9384 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009385 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9386 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9387 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009388
9389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9391
9392 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9393
9394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009395option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009396option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009397no option redispatch
9398 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9400 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009401 Arguments :
9402 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9403 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9404 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009405 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009406 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009407 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009408 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9409 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9410 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009412
9413 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9414 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9415 be able to access the service anymore.
9416
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009417 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9418 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009419
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009420 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9421 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9422 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9423 following order:
9424
9425 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9426
9427 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9428 list, or
9429
9430 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9431
9432 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9433 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9434
9435 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9436 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9437 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9438 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9439
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009440 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009441 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9442 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009444 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9445 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9446
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009447 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009448
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009449
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009450option redis-check
9451 Use redis health checks for server testing
9452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9453 yes | no | yes | yes
9454 Arguments : none
9455
9456 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9457 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9458 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9459 find the "+PONG" response message.
9460
9461 Example :
9462 option redis-check
9463
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009464 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009465
9466
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009467option smtpchk
9468option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9469 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9471 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009472 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009473 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009474 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009475 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9476
9477 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9478 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9479 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9480
9481 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9482 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9483 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9484 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9485 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9486 dead server.
9487
9488 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9489 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009490 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009491 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9492
9493 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9494 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9495 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9496 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009497 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009498
9499 Example :
9500 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9501
9502 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009505option socket-stats
9506no option socket-stats
9507
9508 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9510 yes | yes | yes | no
9511
9512 Arguments : none
9513
9514
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009515option splice-auto
9516no option splice-auto
9517 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9519 yes | yes | yes | yes
9520 Arguments : none
9521
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009522 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009523 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009524 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009525 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009526 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009527 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9528 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9529 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9530 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9531
9532 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9533 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9534 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9535 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9536 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9537 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9538 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9539 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9540 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9541 keyword.
9542
9543 Example :
9544 option splice-auto
9545
9546 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9547 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9548
9549 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9550 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9551
9552
9553option splice-request
9554no option splice-request
9555 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9557 yes | yes | yes | yes
9558 Arguments : none
9559
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009560 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009561 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009562 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9563 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9564 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9565 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9566
9567 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9568
9569 Example :
9570 option splice-request
9571
9572 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9573 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9574
9575 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9576 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9577
9578
9579option splice-response
9580no option splice-response
9581 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9583 yes | yes | yes | yes
9584 Arguments : none
9585
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009586 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009587 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009588 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9589 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9590 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9591 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9592
9593 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9594
9595 Example :
9596 option splice-response
9597
9598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9600
9601 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9602 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9603
9604
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009605option spop-check
9606 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9608 no | no | no | yes
9609 Arguments : none
9610
9611 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9612 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9613 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9614 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9615
9616 Example :
9617 option spop-check
9618
9619 See also : "option httpchk"
9620
9621
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009622option srvtcpka
9623no option srvtcpka
9624 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9626 yes | no | yes | yes
9627 Arguments : none
9628
9629 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9630 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009632 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9633
9634 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9635 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9636 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9637 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9638
9639 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9640 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9641 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9642 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9643 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9644
9645 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9646
9647 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9648 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9649 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9650
9651 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9652 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9653
9654 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9655
9656
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009657option ssl-hello-chk
9658 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9660 yes | no | yes | yes
9661 Arguments : none
9662
9663 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9664 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9665 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9666 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9667 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9668 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9669 hello message.
9670
9671 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9672 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9673 messages, which is appreciable.
9674
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009675 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009676 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9677 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009678
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009679 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9680
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009681
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009682option tcp-check
9683 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9684 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9685 yes | no | yes | yes
9686
9687 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9688 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9689
9690 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9691 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9692 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9693
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009694 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009695 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9696 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9697 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9698 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9699 only.
9700
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009701 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009702 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009703 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9704 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9705 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9706
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009707 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009708 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9709 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009710 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009711 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9712 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9713 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9714 the respective protocols.
9715 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009716 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009717
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009718 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009719
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009720 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9721 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9722 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9723 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009724
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009725 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9726 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9727 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009728
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009729
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009730 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009731 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009732 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009733 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009734
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009735 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009736 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009737 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009738
9739 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9740 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009741 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009742 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009743 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009744 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009745 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009746 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009747 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9748 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009749 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009750 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9751 tcp-check expect string +OK
9752
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009753 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009754 (send many headers before analyzing)
9755 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009756 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009757 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9758 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9759 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9760 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009761 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009762
9763
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009764 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009765
9766
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009767option tcp-smart-accept
9768no option tcp-smart-accept
9769 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9771 yes | yes | yes | no
9772 Arguments : none
9773
9774 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9775 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9776 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9777 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9778 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9779 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9780
9781 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9782 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9783 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9784 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9785
9786 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9787 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9788 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009789 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009790
9791 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9792 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9793 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9794
9795 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9796 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9797 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9798
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009799 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9800
9801
9802option tcp-smart-connect
9803no option tcp-smart-connect
9804 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9806 yes | no | yes | yes
9807 Arguments : none
9808
9809 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9810 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9811 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9812 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9813 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9814
9815 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9816 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9817 complex.
9818
9819 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9820 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9821 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9822
9823 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9824 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9825
9826 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9827
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009828
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009829option tcpka
9830 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9832 yes | yes | yes | yes
9833 Arguments : none
9834
9835 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9836 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009837 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009838 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9839
9840 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9841 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9842 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9843 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9844
9845 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9846 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9847 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9848 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9849 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9850
9851 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9852
9853 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9854 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9855 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9856 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9857 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9858 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9859 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9860 backends.
9861
9862 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9863
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009864
9865option tcplog
9866 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009868 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009869 Arguments : none
9870
9871 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9872 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9873 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9874 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9875 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9876 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9877 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9878 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9879
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009880 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009882 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009883
9884
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009885option transparent
9886no option transparent
9887 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009889 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009890 Arguments : none
9891
9892 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9893 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9894 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9895 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9896 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9897 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9898 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9899 appropriate server.
9900
9901 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9902 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9903
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009904 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009905 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009906
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009907
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009908external-check command <command>
9909 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9911 yes | no | yes | yes
9912
9913 Arguments :
9914 <command> is the external command to run
9915
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009916 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9917
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009918 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009919
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009920 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9921 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9922 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9923 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9924 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9925 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009926
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009927 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9928
9929 Environment variables :
9930 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9931 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9932
9933 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9934
9935 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9936
9937 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9938 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9939 for a UNIX socket).
9940
9941 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9942
9943 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9944
9945 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9946
9947 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9948
9949 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9950
9951 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9952 socket).
9953
9954 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9955 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9956
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009957 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9958
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009959 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9960 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9961 failed.
9962
9963 Example :
9964 external-check command /bin/true
9965
9966 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9967
9968
9969external-check path <path>
9970 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9972 yes | no | yes | yes
9973
9974 Arguments :
9975 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9976
9977 The default path is "".
9978
9979 Example :
9980 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9981
9982 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9983 "external-check command"
9984
9985
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009986persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009987persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009988 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9990 yes | no | yes | yes
9991 Arguments :
9992 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009993 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9994 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009995
9996 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9997 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009998 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009999 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10000 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10001 forwarded to this server.
10002
10003 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10004 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10005 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010006 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010007 a single "listen" section.
10008
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010009 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10010 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10011 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10012
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010013 Example :
10014 listen tse-farm
10015 bind :3389
10016 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10017 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10018 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10019 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10020 persist rdp-cookie
10021 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010022 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010023 balance rdp-cookie
10024 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10025 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10026
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010027 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010028
10029
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010030rate-limit sessions <rate>
10031 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10033 yes | yes | yes | no
10034 Arguments :
10035 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10036 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10037
10038 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10039 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10040 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010041 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010042 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10043 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10044
10045 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10046 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10047 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10048 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10049
10050 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10051 listen smtp
10052 mode tcp
10053 bind :25
10054 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010055 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010056
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010057 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10058 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10059 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010060
10061 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10062
10063
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010064redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10065redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10066redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010067 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10069 no | yes | yes | yes
10070
10071 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010072 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010073
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010074 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010075 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010076 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10077 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10078 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010079
10080 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10081 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10082 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10083 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10084 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010085 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10086 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10087 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10088 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010089
10090 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10091 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10092 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10093 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10094 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10095 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010096 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010097 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010098 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10099 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10100 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010101
10102 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010103 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10104 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10105 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010106 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010107 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10108 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10109 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10110 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010111
10112 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010113 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010114
10115 - "drop-query"
10116 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10117 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10118 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10119 with a location-type redirect.
10120
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010121 - "append-slash"
10122 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10123 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10124 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10125 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10126
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010127 - "ignore-empty"
10128 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10129 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10130 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10131 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10132 of known paths using a simple map.
10133
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010134 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10135 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10136 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10137 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10138 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10139 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10140 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10141
10142 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10143 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10144 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10145 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10146 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10147 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10148 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010149
10150 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10151 acl clear dst_port 80
10152 acl secure dst_port 8080
10153 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010154 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010155 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010156 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10157
10158 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010159 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10160 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10161 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010162 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010163
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010164 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10165 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10166 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10167
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010168 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010169 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010170
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010171 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010172 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10173 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10174 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010175
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010176 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10177 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10178 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010180 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010181
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010182
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010183retries <value>
10184 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10186 yes | no | yes | yes
10187 Arguments :
10188 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10189 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10190 default value is 3.
10191
10192 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10193 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10194 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10195
10196 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010197 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10198 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010199
10200 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10201 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10202
10203 See also : "option redispatch"
10204
10205
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010206retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010207 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10208 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10209 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010210 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10211 yes | no | yes | yes
10212 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010213 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10214 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10215 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10216 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10217 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010218
10219 none never retry
10220
10221 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10222 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10223
10224 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10225 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10226 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10227 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10228 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10229 processing the request.
10230
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010231 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10232 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10233 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10234 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10235 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10236 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10237 overflow attack for example).
10238
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010239 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10240 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10241 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10242 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10243 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10244 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10245 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10246 amplify denial of service attacks.
10247
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010248 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10249 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10250 considered to be safe to retry.
10251
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010252 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10253 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10254 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10255 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10256 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010257
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010258 all-retryable-errors
10259 retry request for any error that are considered
10260 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10261 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10262 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10263
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010264 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10265 not cumulative.
10266
10267 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10268 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10269 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10270 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10271
10272 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10273 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10274 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10275 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10276 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10277 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10278 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10279 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10280 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10281 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10282 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10283 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10284
10285 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10286 should not use this directive.
10287
10288 The default is "conn-failure".
10289
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010290 Example:
10291 retry-on 503 504
10292
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010293 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10294
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010295server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010296 Declare a server in a backend
10297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10298 no | no | yes | yes
10299 Arguments :
10300 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010301 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010302 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010303
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010304 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10305 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10306 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10307 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010308 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10309 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010310 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010311 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10312 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010313 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10314 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10315 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10316 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10317 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10318 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10319 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010320 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010321 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10322 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10323 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10324 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10325 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10326 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010327 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10328 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010329 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10330 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010331
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010332 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010333 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10334 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10335 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10336 adding this value to the client's port.
10337
10338 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10339 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010340 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010341
10342 Examples :
10343 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10344 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010345 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010346 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10347 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10348 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010349
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010350 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10351 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10352 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10353 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10354 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10355
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010356 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10357 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010358
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010359server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010360 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010361 this backend.
10362 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10363 no | no | yes | yes
10364
10365 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10366 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10367 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10368 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10369 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010370
10371 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10372 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10373
10374 global
10375 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10376
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010377 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010378 load-server-state-from-file
10379
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010380 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010381 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010382
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010383server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10384 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10385 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10387 no | no | yes | yes
10388
10389 Arguments:
10390 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10391
10392 <num | range>
10393 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10394 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10395 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10396 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10397
10398 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10399
10400 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10401
10402 <params*>
10403 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10404 keyword.
10405
10406 Examples:
10407 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10408 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10409 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10410
10411 # or
10412 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10413
10414 # would be equivalent to:
10415 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10416 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10417 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10418
10419
10420
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010421source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010422source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010423source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010424 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10426 yes | no | yes | yes
10427 Arguments :
10428 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10429 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010430
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010431 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010432 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10433 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10434 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10435 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10436 supported prefixes are :
10437 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10438 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10439 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010440 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010441 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10442 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010443
10444 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10445 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010446 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10447 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10448 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010449
10450 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10451 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10452 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10453 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10454 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10455 <addr>.
10456
10457 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10458 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10459 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10460 port.
10461
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010462 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10463 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10464 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10465 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010466 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010467 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10468 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10469 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10470 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10471 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10472 HTTP header.
10473
10474 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10475 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010476 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010477 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10478 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10479 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10480 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10481 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10482 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10483 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10484
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010485 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10486 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10487 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10488 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10489 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10490 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10491
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010492 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10493 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10494 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10495 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10496
10497 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10498 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10499 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10500 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10501 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10502 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10503
10504 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10505 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10506 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10507 there are two methods :
10508
10509 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10510 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10511 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10512 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10513 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10514 of the client ranges may be used.
10515
10516 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10517 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10518 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10519 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10520 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10521 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10522 same session.
10523
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010524 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10525 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10526 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010527 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010528
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010529 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10530
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010531 Examples :
10532 backend private
10533 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10534 source 192.168.1.200
10535
10536 backend transparent_ssl1
10537 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10538 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10539
10540 backend transparent_ssl2
10541 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10542 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10543 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10544
10545 backend transparent_ssl3
10546 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10547 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10548 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10549
10550 backend transparent_smtp
10551 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10552 # with Tproxy version 4.
10553 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10554
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010555 backend transparent_http
10556 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10557 # proxy.
10558 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010560 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010561 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10562
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010563
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010564srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10565 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10566 the connection on the server side.
10567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10568 yes | no | yes | yes
10569 Arguments :
10570 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10571
10572 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10573 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010574 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10575 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010576
10577 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10578
10579
10580srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10581 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10582 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10583 server side.
10584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10585 yes | no | yes | yes
10586 Arguments :
10587 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10588 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10589 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10590 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10591
10592 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10593 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010594 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10595 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010596
10597 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10598
10599
10600srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10601 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10603 yes | no | yes | yes
10604 Arguments :
10605 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10606 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10607 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10608 document.
10609
10610 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10611 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010612 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10613 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010614
10615 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10616
10617
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010618stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10619 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010621 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010622
10623 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10624 matched.
10625
10626 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10627 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10628
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010629 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10630 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10631 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10632 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010633
10634 Example :
10635 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10636 backend stats_localhost
10637 stats enable
10638 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10639
10640 Example :
10641 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10642 backend stats_auth
10643 stats enable
10644 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10645 stats admin if TRUE
10646
10647 Example :
10648 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10649 userlist stats-auth
10650 group admin users admin
10651 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10652 group readonly users haproxy
10653 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10654
10655 backend stats_auth
10656 stats enable
10657 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10658 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10659 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10660 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10661
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010662 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10663 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010664
10665
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010666stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10667 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010669 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010670 Arguments :
10671 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10672
10673 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10674
10675 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10676 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10677 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10678 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10679 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10680 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10681
10682 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10683 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10684 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010685 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010686
10687 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10688 report using "stats scope".
10689
10690 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10691 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10692 unobvious parameters.
10693
10694 Example :
10695 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10696 backend public_www
10697 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10698 stats enable
10699 stats hide-version
10700 stats scope .
10701 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010702 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010703 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10704 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10705
10706 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10707 backend private_monitoring
10708 stats enable
10709 stats uri /admin?stats
10710 stats refresh 5s
10711
10712 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10713
10714
10715stats enable
10716 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010718 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010719 Arguments : none
10720
10721 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10722 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10723 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10724 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10725 - stats auth : no authentication
10726 - stats scope : no restriction
10727
10728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10730 unobvious parameters.
10731
10732 Example :
10733 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10734 backend public_www
10735 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10736 stats enable
10737 stats hide-version
10738 stats scope .
10739 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010740 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010741 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10742 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10743
10744 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10745 backend private_monitoring
10746 stats enable
10747 stats uri /admin?stats
10748 stats refresh 5s
10749
10750 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10751
10752
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010753stats hide-version
10754 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010756 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010757 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010758
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010759 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10760 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10761 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10762 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10763 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10764 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010766 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10767 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10768 unobvious parameters.
10769
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010770 Example :
10771 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10772 backend public_www
10773 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010774 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010775 stats hide-version
10776 stats scope .
10777 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010778 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010779 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10780 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010781
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010782 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10783 backend private_monitoring
10784 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010785 stats uri /admin?stats
10786 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010787
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010788 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010789
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010790
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010791stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10792 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10793 Access control for statistics
10794
10795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10796 no | no | yes | yes
10797
10798 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10799 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10800 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10801 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10802 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10803 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10804
10805 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10806 instance.
10807
10808 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10809 about ACL usage.
10810
10811
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010812stats realm <realm>
10813 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010815 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010816 Arguments :
10817 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10818 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10819 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10820
10821 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10822 using a backslash ('\').
10823
10824 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10825 only related to authentication.
10826
10827 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10828 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10829 unobvious parameters.
10830
10831 Example :
10832 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10833 backend public_www
10834 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10835 stats enable
10836 stats hide-version
10837 stats scope .
10838 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010839 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010840 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10841 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10842
10843 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10844 backend private_monitoring
10845 stats enable
10846 stats uri /admin?stats
10847 stats refresh 5s
10848
10849 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10850
10851
10852stats refresh <delay>
10853 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010855 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010856 Arguments :
10857 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10858 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10859 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10860 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10861 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10862 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10863
10864 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10865 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10866 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010867 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010868
10869 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10870 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10871 unobvious parameters.
10872
10873 Example :
10874 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10875 backend public_www
10876 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10877 stats enable
10878 stats hide-version
10879 stats scope .
10880 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010881 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010882 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10883 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10884
10885 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10886 backend private_monitoring
10887 stats enable
10888 stats uri /admin?stats
10889 stats refresh 5s
10890
10891 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10892
10893
10894stats scope { <name> | "." }
10895 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010897 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010898 Arguments :
10899 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10900 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10901 section in which the statement appears.
10902
10903 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10904 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10905 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10906 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10907 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10908 exists.
10909
10910 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10911 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10912 unobvious parameters.
10913
10914 Example :
10915 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10916 backend public_www
10917 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10918 stats enable
10919 stats hide-version
10920 stats scope .
10921 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010922 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010923 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10924 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10925
10926 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10927 backend private_monitoring
10928 stats enable
10929 stats uri /admin?stats
10930 stats refresh 5s
10931
10932 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10933
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010934
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010935stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010936 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010938 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010939
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010940 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10942
10943 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10944 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10945
10946 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10947 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010948 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010949
10950 Example :
10951 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10952 backend private_monitoring
10953 stats enable
10954 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10955 stats uri /admin?stats
10956 stats refresh 5s
10957
10958 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10959 global section.
10960
10961
10962stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010963 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10965 yes | yes | yes | yes
10966 Arguments : none
10967
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010968 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010969 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10970 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10971 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10972 - IP (socket, server)
10973 - cookie (backend, server)
10974
10975 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10976 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010977 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010978
10979 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10980
10981
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010982stats show-modules
10983 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10985 yes | yes | yes | yes
10986 Arguments : none
10987
10988 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10989 values as a tooltip.
10990
10991 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10992 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10993 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10994
10995 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10996
10997
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010998stats show-node [ <name> ]
10999 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011001 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011002 Arguments:
11003 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11004 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11005
11006 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11007 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011008 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011009
11010 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11011 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11012 unobvious parameters.
11013
11014 Example:
11015 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11016 backend private_monitoring
11017 stats enable
11018 stats show-node Europe-1
11019 stats uri /admin?stats
11020 stats refresh 5s
11021
11022 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11023 section.
11024
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011025
11026stats uri <prefix>
11027 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011029 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011030 Arguments :
11031 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11032 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11033 query string.
11034
11035 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11036 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11037 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11038 possible to reach it in the application.
11039
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011040 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011041 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011042 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11043 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11044 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11045 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11046
11047 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11048 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11049 an address or a port to statistics only.
11050
11051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11053 unobvious parameters.
11054
11055 Example :
11056 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11057 backend public_www
11058 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11059 stats enable
11060 stats hide-version
11061 stats scope .
11062 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011063 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011064 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11065 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11066
11067 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11068 backend private_monitoring
11069 stats enable
11070 stats uri /admin?stats
11071 stats refresh 5s
11072
11073 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11074
11075
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011076stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11077 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011079 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011080
11081 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011082 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011083 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011084 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011085 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11086
11087 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11088 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11089 the "stick-table" statement.
11090
11091 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11092 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11093 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11094 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11095 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11096
11097 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11098 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11099 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11100 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11101 transformation rules.
11102
11103 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11104 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11105 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11106 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11107 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11108 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11109 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11110
11111 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11112 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11113 ACL based conditions.
11114
11115 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11116 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11117 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11118 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11119
11120 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11121 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11122 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11123 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11124
11125 Example :
11126 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11127 # last 30 minutes
11128 backend pop
11129 mode tcp
11130 balance roundrobin
11131 stick store-request src
11132 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11133 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11134 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11135
11136 backend smtp
11137 mode tcp
11138 balance roundrobin
11139 stick match src table pop
11140 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11141 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11142
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011143 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11144 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011145
11146
11147stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11148 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11150 no | no | yes | yes
11151
11152 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11153 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11154 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11155 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11156
11157 Examples :
11158 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011159 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011160
11161 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11162 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11163 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11164
11165
11166 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11167 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11168 backend http
11169 mode http
11170 balance roundrobin
11171 stick on src table https
11172 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11173 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11174 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11175
11176 backend https
11177 mode tcp
11178 balance roundrobin
11179 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11180 stick on src
11181 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11182 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11183
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011184 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011185
11186
11187stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11188 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11190 no | no | yes | yes
11191
11192 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011193 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011194 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011195 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011196 server is selected.
11197
11198 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11199 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11200 the "stick-table" statement.
11201
11202 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11203 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11204 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11205 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11206 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11207 address.
11208
11209 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11210 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11211 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11212 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11213 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11214 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11215 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11216 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11217 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11218 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11219
11220 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11221 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11222 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11223 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11224 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11225 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11226 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11227
11228 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11229 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11230 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11231 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11232
11233 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11234 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11235 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11236 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11237 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11238 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011239 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11240 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11241 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11242 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11243 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11244 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011245
11246 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11247 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11248 the request.
11249
11250 Example :
11251 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11252 # last 30 minutes
11253 backend pop
11254 mode tcp
11255 balance roundrobin
11256 stick store-request src
11257 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11258 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11259 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11260
11261 backend smtp
11262 mode tcp
11263 balance roundrobin
11264 stick match src table pop
11265 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11266 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11267
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011268 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011269
11270
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011271stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011272 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011273 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011274 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011276 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011277
11278 Arguments :
11279 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11280 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11281 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11282 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11283
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011284 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11285 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11286 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11287 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11288
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011289 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11290 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11291 instance.
11292
11293 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11294 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11295 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11296 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11297 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11298 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011299 to 32 characters.
11300
11301 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11302 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11303 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011304 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011305 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11306 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011307
11308 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011309 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11310 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011311 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11312 increase.
11313
11314 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011315 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11316 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11317 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011318
11319 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011320 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011321 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11322 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011323 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011324 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11325 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11326 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11327 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11328 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11329 parameter (see below).
11330
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011331 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11332 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11333 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11334 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11335 soft restart.
11336
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011337 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11338 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11339 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11340 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011341 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011342 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011343 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11344 if not expiration delay is specified.
11345
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011346 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11347 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11348 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11349 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11350 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11351 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11352 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11353 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11354 token.
11355
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011356 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11357 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11358 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11359 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011360 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11361 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11362 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11363 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11364 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11365 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11366 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11367 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11368 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11369 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11370 types and their arguments.
11371
11372 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11373 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11374 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11375 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11376
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011377 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11378 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11379 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11380 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11381 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11382 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11383 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11384 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11385 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11386 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011387 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11388 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11389 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11390 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011391
11392 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11393 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11394 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11395 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11396 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11397 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11398 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11399 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11400 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11401 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11402 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11403 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011404 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11405 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11406 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11407 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011408
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011409 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11410 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11411 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011412 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011413
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011414 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11415 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11416 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011417 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011418 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011419 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011420
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011421 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11422 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11423 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11424 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11425
11426 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11427 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11428 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11429 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11430 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11431 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11432
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011433 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11434 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11435 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11436 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11437 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11438 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11439 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11440 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11441 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11442 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011443 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11444 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11445 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011446
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011447 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11448 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11449 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11450 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11451
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011452 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11453 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11454 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11455 they were received.
11456
11457 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11458 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11459 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11460 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11461 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11462
11463 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11464 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11465 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11466 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11467 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11468
11469 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11470 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11471 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11472
11473 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11474 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11475 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11476 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11477 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11478
11479 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11480 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11481 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11482 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11483 the client side.
11484
11485 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11486 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11487 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11488 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11489 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11490 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11491 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11492
11493 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11494 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11495 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11496 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11497 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11498 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011499 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011500
11501 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11502 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11503 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11504 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11505 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11506 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11507
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011508 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11509 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11510 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11511 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11512 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11513
11514 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11515 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11516 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11517 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11518 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11519 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11520
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011521 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011522 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011523 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11524 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11525
11526 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11527 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11528 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11529 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11530 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11531 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11532 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11533 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11534 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11535 recommended for better fairness.
11536
11537 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011538 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011539 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11540 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11541
11542 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11543 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11544 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11545 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11546 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11547 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11548 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11549 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11550 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11551 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011552
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011553 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11554 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011555 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11556 reference it.
11557
11558 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11559 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011560 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11561 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11562 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011563
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011564 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11565 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11566 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11567 something that can be ignored.
11568
11569 Example:
11570 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11571 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11572 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11573 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11574
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011575 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011576 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011577
11578
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011579stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011580 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11582 no | no | yes | yes
11583
11584 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011585 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011586 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011587 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011588 server is selected.
11589
11590 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11591 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11592 the "stick-table" statement.
11593
11594 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11595 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11596 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11597 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11598
11599 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11600 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11601 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11602 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11603 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11604 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011605 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011606 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11607 rules.
11608
11609 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11610 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11611 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11612 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11613 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11614 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11615 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11616
11617 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11618 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11619 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11620 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11621
11622 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11623 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11624 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11625 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11626 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11627 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011628 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11629 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11630 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11631 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11632 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11633 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11634 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11635 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11636 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011637
11638 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11639
11640 Example :
11641 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11642 backend https
11643 mode tcp
11644 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011645 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011646 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011647
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011648 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11649 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011650
11651 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11652 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11653 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11654
11655 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11656 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011657
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011658 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11659 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11660 # at offset 44.
11661
11662 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011663 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011664
11665 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011666 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011667
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011668 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11669 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11670
11671 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11672 extraction.
11673
11674
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011675tcp-check comment <string>
11676 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11677 it fails.
11678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11679 yes | no | yes | yes
11680
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011681 Arguments :
11682 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11683 rule fails.
11684
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011685 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11686 user-friendly error reporting.
11687
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011688 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11689 "tcp-check expect".
11690
11691
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011692tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11693 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011694 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011695 Opens a new connection
11696 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011697 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011698
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011699 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011700 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11701
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011702 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011703 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011704
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011705 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011706 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11707 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011708 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011709
11710 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011711
11712 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11713
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011714 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11715
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011716 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11717
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011718 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11719
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011720 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11721 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11722 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11723 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11724
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011725 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11726 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11727 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11728 haproxy -vv.
11729
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011730 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011731
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011732 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11733 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11734 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11735
11736 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11737 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11738 of the sequence.
11739
11740 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11741 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11742 do.
11743
11744 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11745 unset-var or comment rules.
11746
11747 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011748 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11749 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11750 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11751 option tcp-check
11752 tcp-check connect
11753 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11754 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11755 tcp-check send \r\n
11756 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11757 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11758 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11759 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11760 tcp-check send \r\n
11761 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11762 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11763
11764 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11765 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011766 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011767 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11768 tcp-check connect port 143
11769 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11770 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11771
11772 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11773
11774
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011775tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011776 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011777 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011778 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011779 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011780 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011781 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011782
11783 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011784 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11785
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011786 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11787 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11788 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11789 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11790 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11791 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11792 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11793 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11794 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11795 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11796
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011797 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011798 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11799 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011800 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11801 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11802 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11803
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011804 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11805 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11806 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011807 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11808 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011809 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11810 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011811 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11812 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011813 By default "L7OK" is used.
11814
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011815 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11816 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011817 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11818 supported :
11819 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11820 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011821 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11822 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11823 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11824 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11825 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011826
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011827 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011828 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011829 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11830 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11831 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11832 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011833 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11834
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011835 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11836 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11837 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11838 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11839
11840 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11841 informational message reported in logs if an error
11842 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11843 log-format string.
11844
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011845 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11846 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11847 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11848 followed by some converters.
11849
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011850 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11851 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11852 with the usual backslash ('\').
11853 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011854 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011855 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11856 used upper or lower case.
11857
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011858 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11859
11860 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11861 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11862 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11863 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11864 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11865 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11866 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11867 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11868
11869 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11870 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11871 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11872 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11873 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11874 expression.
11875
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011876 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11877 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11878 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11879 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11880 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11881 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11882
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011883 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11884 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11885 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11886 this exact hexadecimal string.
11887 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11888
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011889 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11890 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11891 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11892 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11893 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11894 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11895 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11896 size.
11897
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011898 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11899 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11900 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11901 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11902 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11903 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11904 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11905 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11906 in a binary string before matching the response's
11907 buffer.
11908
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011909 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011910 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011911 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11912 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11913 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11914 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11915 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11916 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11917 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11918 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11919 the null character.
11920
11921 Examples :
11922 # perform a POP check
11923 option tcp-check
11924 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11925
11926 # perform an IMAP check
11927 option tcp-check
11928 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11929
11930 # look for the redis master server
11931 option tcp-check
11932 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011933 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011934 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11935 tcp-check expect string role:master
11936 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11937 tcp-check expect string +OK
11938
11939
11940 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011941 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011942
11943
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011944tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11945tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11946 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11947 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011949 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011950
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011951 Arguments :
11952 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11953
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011954 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11955 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011956
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011957 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11958 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011959
11960 Examples :
11961 # look for the redis master server
11962 option tcp-check
11963 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11964 tcp-check expect string role:master
11965
11966 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011967 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011968
11969
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011970tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11971tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11972 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11973 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011975 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011976
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011977 Arguments :
11978 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011979
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011980 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11981 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011982
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011983 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11984 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11985 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011986
11987 Examples :
11988 # redis check in binary
11989 option tcp-check
11990 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11991 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11992
11993
11994 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011995 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011996
11997
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010011998tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
11999tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012000 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012002 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012003
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012004 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012005 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12006 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12009 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12010 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12011 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12012 and '-'.
12013
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012014 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12015 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012016 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012017 conditions.
12018
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012019 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12020
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012021 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12022 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12023
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012024 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012025 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012026 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012027
12028
12029tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012030 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012032 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012033
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012034 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012035 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12036 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12037 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12038 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12039 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12040 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12041 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12042 and '-'.
12043
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012044 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012045 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12046
12047
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012048tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012049 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012051 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012052 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012053 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12054 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012055
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012056 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012057
12058 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12059 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012060 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12061 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12062 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12063 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12064 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12065 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012066
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012067 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12068 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12069 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012070 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12071 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12072 is true.
12073
12074 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12075 supported:
12076 - accept
12077 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12078 - expect-proxy layer4
12079 - reject
12080 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12081 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12082 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12083 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12084 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12085 - set-dst <expr>
12086 - set-dst-port <expr>
12087 - set-mark <mark>
12088 - set-src <expr>
12089 - set-src-port <expr>
12090 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012091 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12092 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012093 - silent-drop
12094 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12095 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12096 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012097 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012098
12099 The supported actions are described below.
12100
12101 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12102 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012103
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012104 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12105 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12106 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12107 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12108 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12109 a defaults section defining such rules.
12110
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012111 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12112 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12113 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012114
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012115 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12116 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12117 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012118
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012119 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12120 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12121 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012122
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012123 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12124 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12125 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012126
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012127 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12128 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12129 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012130
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012131 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012132
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012133 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012134
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012135 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012136
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012137 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012138
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012139tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012140
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012141 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12142 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012143
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012144tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12145 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012146
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012147 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12148 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12149 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12150 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12151 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12152 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12153 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012154
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012155tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012156
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012157 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12158 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12159 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12160 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12161 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12162 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012163
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012164tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012165
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012166 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12167 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12168 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12169 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12170 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12171 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12172 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12173 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12174 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12175 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12176 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012177
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012178tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12179tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12180tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012181
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012182 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12183 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12184 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12185 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012186
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012187tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12188 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12189tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12190 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012191
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012192 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12193 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12194 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012195
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012196tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12197tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012198
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012199 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12200 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12201 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012202
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012203tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012204
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012205 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12206 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12207 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012208
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012209tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12210tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012211
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012212 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12213 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12214 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012215
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012216tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012217
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012218 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12219 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12220 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012221
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012222tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12223tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012224
12225 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12226 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12227 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12228 for a complete description.
12229
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012230tcp-request connection silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012231
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012232 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12233 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12234 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12235 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012236
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012237tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12238tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12239tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012240
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012241 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12242 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12243 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012244
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012245tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12246
12247 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12248 details about variables.
12249
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012250
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012251tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12252 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012254 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012255 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012256 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12257 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012259 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012260
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012261 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012262 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12263 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012264 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12265 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012267 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12268 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12269 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12270 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012271 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012272 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012273 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12274 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12275 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12276 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012277 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012278 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012280 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12281 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12282 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12283 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012284
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012285 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12286 supported:
12287 - accept
12288 - capture <sample> len <length>
12289 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12290 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012291 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012292 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012293 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012294 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012295 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012296 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012297 - set-dst <expr>
12298 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012299 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012300 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012301 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012302 - set-priority-class <expr>
12303 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012304 - set-src <expr>
12305 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012306 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012307 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12308 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012309 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012310 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012311 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12312 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12313 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012314 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012315 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012316
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012317 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012318
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012319 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12320 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12321 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12322 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12323 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12324 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012325
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012326 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12327 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12328 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12329 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12330 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12331 a defaults section defining such rules.
12332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012333 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012334 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12335 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012336
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012337 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12338 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12339 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12340 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12341 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12342 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12343
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012344 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012345 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12346 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12347 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12348 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12349 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12350 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12351 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12352 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12353 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12354 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012355
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012356 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012357 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12358 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12359 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012360
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012361 Example:
12362 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12363
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012364 Example:
12365
12366 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012367 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012368 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012369
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012370 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012371 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012372 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012373 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12374 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012375 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012376 tcp-request content reject
12377
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012378 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12379 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12380 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12381 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12382 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12383 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12384 ...
12385 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12386
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012387 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012388 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12389 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012390 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012391 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012392
12393 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12394 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012395 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012396 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012397 tcp-request content reject
12398
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012399 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012400 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012401 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012402 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012403 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12404 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012405
12406 Example:
12407 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12408 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012409 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012410
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012411 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012412 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012413
12414 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012415 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012416 # protecting all our sites
12417 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012418 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12419 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012420 ...
12421 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12422
12423 backend http_dynamic
12424 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012425 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012426 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012427 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012428 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012429 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012430 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012432 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012433
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012434 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12435 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012436
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012437tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12438
12439 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012440 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012441
12442tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12443 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12444
12445 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12446 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12447 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
12448 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
12449 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
12450 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
12451 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
12452 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
12453 information.
12454
12455tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12456
12457 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
12458 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
12459 complete description.
12460
12461tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12462
12463 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
12464 are evaluated.
12465
12466tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12467tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12468tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12469
12470 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12471 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12472 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12473 description.
12474
12475tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12476 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12477tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12478 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12479
12480 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12481 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12482 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
12483
12484tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12485 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12486
12487 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12488 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
12489
12490tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12491tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12492
12493 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12494 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12495 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12496
12497tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12498
12499 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12500 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
12501
12502tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12503
12504 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12505 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12506 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12507
12508tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12509
12510 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12511 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
12512
12513tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12514
12515 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
12516 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
12517
12518tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12519
12520 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
12521 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
12522 description.
12523
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012524tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12525tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12526
12527 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12528 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12529 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12530
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012531tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12532
12533 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12534 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12535 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12536
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012537tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12538tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012539
12540 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12541 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12542 for a complete description.
12543
12544tcp-request content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12545
12546 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12547 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12548 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12549 complete description.
12550
12551tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
12552 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12553
12554 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
12555 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
12556 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
12557 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
12558 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
12559 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
12560 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
12561 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
12562 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
12563 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12564
12565 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12566
12567tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12568tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12569tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12570
12571 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12572 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12573 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12574
12575tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12576
12577 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12578 details about variables.
12579
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020012580tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012581
12582 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
12583 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
12584 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
12585 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
12586 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
12587
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012588
12589tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12590 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012592 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012593 Arguments :
12594 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12595 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12596 as explained at the top of this document.
12597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012598 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012599 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12600 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12601 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12602 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12603
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012604 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12605 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12606 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12607 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12608
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012609 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012610 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012611 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012612 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012613 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012614 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12615 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12616 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012617
12618 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12619 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12620 it pass through unaffected.
12621
12622 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12623 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12624 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012625 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012626 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12627 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012628 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12629 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12630 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012631
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012632 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12633 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12634
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012635 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012636 "timeout client".
12637
12638
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012639tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12640 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012642 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012643 Arguments :
12644 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12645 below.
12646
12647 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12648
12649 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
12650 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12651 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12652 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053012653 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012654 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12655 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12656 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
12657 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
12658 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12659 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12660 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12661 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12662 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12663 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12664 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12665 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12666 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12667 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12668 instead.
12669
12670 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12671 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12672 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12673 rules which may be inserted.
12674
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012675 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12676 supported:
12677 - accept
12678 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012679 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12680 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12681 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12682 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12683 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012684 - set-dst <expr>
12685 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012686 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012687 - set-src <expr>
12688 - set-src-port <expr>
12689 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012690 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12691 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012692 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012693 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12694 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12695 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
12696 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012697
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012698 The supported actions are described below.
12699
12700 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12701 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12702 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12703 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12704 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12705 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012706
12707 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12708 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12709 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12710
12711 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12712 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12713 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12714 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12715 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12716
12717 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12718 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12719
12720 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12721 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12722 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12723
12724 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12725 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12726 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12727
12728 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12729 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12730 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12731
12732 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12733 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12734 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12735
12736 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12737
12738 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12739
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012740tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12741
12742 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
12743 rules are evaluated.
12744
12745tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12746
12747 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
12748 are evaluated.
12749
12750tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12751tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12752tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12753
12754 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12755 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12756 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12757 description.
12758
12759tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12760 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12761tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12762 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12763
12764 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12765 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
12766 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
12767 description.
12768
12769tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12770tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12771
12772 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12773 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12774 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12775
12776tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12777
12778 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12779 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12780 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12781
12782tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12783tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12784
12785 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12786 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12787 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12788
12789tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12790
12791 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12792 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12793 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12794
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012795tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12796tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012797
12798 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12799 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12800 for a complete description.
12801
12802tcp-request session silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12803
12804 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12805 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12806 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12807 complete description.
12808
12809tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12810tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12811tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12812
12813 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12814 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12815 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12816
12817tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12818
12819 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12820 details about variables.
12821
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012822
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012823tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12824 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012826 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012827 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012828 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12829 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012830
12831 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12832
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012833 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012834 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12835 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012836 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12837 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012838
12839 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12840
12841 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12842 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12843 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12844 inserted.
12845
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012846 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12847 supported:
12848 - accept
12849 - close
12850 - reject
12851 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12852 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12853 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12854 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12855 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12856 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12857 - set-log-level <level>
12858 - set-mark <mark>
12859 - set-nice <nice>
12860 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012861 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12862 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012863 - silent-drop
12864 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12865
12866 The supported actions are described below.
12867
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012868 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12869 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12870 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12871 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12872 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12873 a defaults section defining such rules.
12874
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012875 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12876 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12877 for changing the default action to a reject.
12878
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012879 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012880
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012881 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12882 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12883 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12884 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
12885 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012886
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012887 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012888
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012889 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012890
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012891tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012892
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012893 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
12894 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012895
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012896tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012897
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012898 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
12899 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
12900 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
12901 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
12902 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
12903 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012904
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012905tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012906
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012907 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
12908 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012909
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012910tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12911tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12912tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012913
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012914 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12915 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12916 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12917 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012918
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012919tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12920 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12921tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12922 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012923
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012924 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12925 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12926 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012927
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012928tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12929 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012930
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012931 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12932 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012933
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012934tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012935
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012936 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12937 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012938
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012939tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012940
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012941 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12942 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12943 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012944
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012945tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012946
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012947 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12948 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012949
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012950tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012951
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012952 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12953 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12954 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012955
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012956tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12957tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012958
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012959 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12960 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12961 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012962
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012963tcp-response content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012964
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012965 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12966 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12967 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12968 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012969
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012970tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012971
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012972 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12973 details about variables.
12974
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012975
12976tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12977 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012979 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012980 Arguments :
12981 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12982 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12983 as explained at the top of this document.
12984
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012985 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12986 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012987
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012988 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12989
12990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012991timeout check <timeout>
12992 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12993 established.
12994
12995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12996 yes | no | yes | yes
12997 Arguments:
12998 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13000 as explained at the top of this document.
13001
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013002 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013003 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013004 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013005 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013006 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13007 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13008 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013009
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013010 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013011 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13012
13013 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13014 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013015 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013016
13017 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13018 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13019 forget about it.
13020
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013021 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13022 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13023
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013024 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13025 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013026
13027
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013028timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013029 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13031 yes | yes | yes | no
13032 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013033 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013034 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13035 as explained at the top of this document.
13036
13037 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13038 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13039 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013040 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13041 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13042 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13043 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013044 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13045 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13046 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013047 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013048 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013049 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13050 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013051 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13052 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013053
13054 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13055 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13056 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13057 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013058 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013059 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13060
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013061 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013062
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013063
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013064timeout client-fin <timeout>
13065 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13067 yes | yes | yes | no
13068 Arguments :
13069 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13070 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13071 as explained at the top of this document.
13072
13073 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13074 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13075 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13076 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13077 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13078 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13079 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013080 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13081 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13082 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013083
13084 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13085 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13086 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13087
13088 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13089
13090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013091timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013092 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13094 yes | no | yes | yes
13095 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013096 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013097 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13098 as explained at the top of this document.
13099
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013100 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013101 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013102 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013103 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013104 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13105 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013106
13107 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13108 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13109 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13110 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013111 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013112 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13113
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013114 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013116
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013117timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13118 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13120 yes | yes | yes | yes
13121 Arguments :
13122 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13123 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13124 as explained at the top of this document.
13125
13126 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13127 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13128 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13129 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13130 once the request has started to present itself.
13131
13132 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13133 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13134 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13135 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13136 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13137
13138 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13139 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13140 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13141 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13142
13143 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13144 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013145 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013146 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13147 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013148 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013149
13150 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13151 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13152 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13153 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13154
13155 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13156
13157
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013158timeout http-request <timeout>
13159 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013161 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013162 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013163 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013164 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13165 as explained at the top of this document.
13166
13167 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13168 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13169 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13170 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13171 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13172 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13173 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013174 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13175 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13176 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13177 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013178 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013179 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13180 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013181
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013182 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13183 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13184 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13185 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13186 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013187 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013188
13189 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13190 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013191 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013192 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13193 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13194
13195 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013196 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13197 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13198 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013199
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013200 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013201 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013202
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013203
13204timeout queue <timeout>
13205 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13207 yes | no | yes | yes
13208 Arguments :
13209 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13211 as explained at the top of this document.
13212
13213 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13214 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13215 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13216 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13217 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13218
13219 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13220 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13221 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13222 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13223
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013224 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013225
13226
13227timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013228 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13230 yes | no | yes | yes
13231 Arguments :
13232 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13233 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13234 as explained at the top of this document.
13235
13236 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13237 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13238 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13239 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13240 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13241 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13242 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13243
13244 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13245 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13246 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13247 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13248 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013249 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013250 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013251 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13252 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013253 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13254 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013255
13256 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13257 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13258 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13259 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013260 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013261 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13262
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013263 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013264
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013265
13266timeout server-fin <timeout>
13267 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13269 yes | no | yes | yes
13270 Arguments :
13271 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13272 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13273 as explained at the top of this document.
13274
13275 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13276 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13277 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13278 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13279 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13280 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13281 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13282 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13283 situations, it should not be needed.
13284
13285 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13286 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13287 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13288
13289 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13290
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013291
13292timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013293 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13295 yes | yes | yes | yes
13296 Arguments :
13297 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13298 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13299 as explained at the top of this document.
13300
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013301 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13302 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13303 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013304
13305 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13306 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13307 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13308 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013309 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013310
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013311 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013312
13313
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013314timeout tunnel <timeout>
13315 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13317 yes | no | yes | yes
13318 Arguments :
13319 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13320 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13321 as explained at the top of this document.
13322
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013323 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013324 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13325 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13326 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013327 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13328 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013329 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13330 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13331 specified.
13332
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013333 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13334 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13335 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13336 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13337 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13338 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13339 state.
13340
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013341 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13342 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13343 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13344 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013345 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013346
13347 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13348 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13349 forget about it.
13350
13351 Example :
13352 defaults http
13353 option http-server-close
13354 timeout connect 5s
13355 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013356 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013357 timeout server 30s
13358 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13359
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013360 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013361
13362
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013363transparent (deprecated)
13364 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013366 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013367 Arguments : none
13368
13369 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13370 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13371 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13372 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13373 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13374 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13375 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13376 appropriate server.
13377
13378 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13379
13380 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13381 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13382
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013383 See also: "option transparent"
13384
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013385unique-id-format <string>
13386 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13388 yes | yes | yes | no
13389 Arguments :
13390 <string> is a log-format string.
13391
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013392 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13393 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13394 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13395 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013396
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013397 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013398 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013399 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13400 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13401 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13402 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13403 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13404 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013405
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013406 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13407 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013408
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013409 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013410
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013411 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013412
13413 will generate:
13414
13415 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13416
13417 See also: "unique-id-header"
13418
13419unique-id-header <name>
13420 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13422 yes | yes | yes | no
13423 Arguments :
13424 <name> is the name of the header.
13425
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013426 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13427 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013428
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013429 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013430
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013431 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013432 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13433
13434 will generate:
13435
13436 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13437
13438 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013439
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013440use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013441 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13443 no | yes | yes | no
13444 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013445 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13446 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013447
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013448 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13449 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013450
13451 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13452 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13453 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013454 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013455 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013456 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13457 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013458
13459 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13460 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13461 assign the backend.
13462
13463 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13464 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13465 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13466 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13467 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13468 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13469
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013470 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013471 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013472 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13473 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13474 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13475
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013476 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13477 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13478 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13479 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13480 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13481 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13482 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13483 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13484 cannot be forced from the request.
13485
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013486 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013487 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13488 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13489
13490 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13491 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013492
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013493use-fcgi-app <name>
13494 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13496 no | no | yes | yes
13497 Arguments :
13498 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13499
13500 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013501
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013502use-server <server> if <condition>
13503use-server <server> unless <condition>
13504 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13506 no | no | yes | yes
13507 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013508 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13509 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013510
13511 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13512
13513 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13514 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13515 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13516
13517 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13518 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13519 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13520 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13521 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13522 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13523 matches will assign the server.
13524
13525 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13526 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13527 with the next rules until one matches.
13528
13529 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13530 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13531 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13532 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13533
13534 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13535 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13536 stripped.
13537
13538 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13539 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013540 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013541 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013542 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013543
13544 Example :
13545 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013546 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013547 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013548 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013549 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013550 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013551 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013552 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13553 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13554
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013555 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13556 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13557 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13558 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013559 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013560 and we fall back to load balancing.
13561
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013562 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013563
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013564
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135655. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013566--------------------------
13567
13568The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13569depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13570settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13571written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13572described in this section.
13573
13574
135755.1. Bind options
13576-----------------
13577
13578The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13579as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13580no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13581parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13582while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13583provided immediately after the setting name.
13584
13585The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13586
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013587accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13588 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13589 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13590 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13591 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13592 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13593 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13594 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13595 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13596 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013597 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13598 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13599 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013600
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013601accept-proxy
13602 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013603 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13604 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013605 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13606 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13607 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13608 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013609 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013610 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13611 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013612 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13613 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013614
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013615allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013616 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013617 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013618 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013619 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13620 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013621
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013622alpn <protocols>
13623 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13624 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13625 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013626 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013627 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013628 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13629 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13630 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13631 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13632 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13633 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13634 preference, like below :
13635
13636 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013637
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013638backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013639 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013640 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13641
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013642curves <curves>
13643 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13644 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13645 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13646 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13647 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13648 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13649
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013650ecdhe <named curve>
13651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013652 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13653 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013654
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013655ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013656 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13657 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020013658 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
13659 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
13660 .crl" available in the directory.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013661
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013662ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13663 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13664 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13665 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13666 error is ignored.
13667
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013668ca-sign-file <cafile>
13669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13670 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13671 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13672 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13673 'generate-certificates' for details.
13674
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013675ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13677 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13678 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13679 'generate-certificates' for details.
13680
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013681ca-verify-file <cafile>
13682 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13683 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13684 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13685 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13686 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13687
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013688ciphers <ciphers>
13689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13690 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013691 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013692 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013693 information and recommendations see e.g.
13694 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13695 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13696 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13697
13698ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13699 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13700 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13701 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13702 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013703 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13704 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013705
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013706crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13708 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013709 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13710 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013711
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013712crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13714 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13715 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13716 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13717 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013718 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13719 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013720
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013721 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13722 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13723
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013724 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13725 are loaded.
13726
13727 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013728 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13729 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13730 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13731 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13732 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13733 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13734 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013735 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013736
13737 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13738 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13739 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13740 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013741 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13742 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013743
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013744 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013747 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013748 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13749 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013750 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13751 clients).
13752
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013753 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013754 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13755 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13756 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13757 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13758 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13759 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13760 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13761 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13762 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13763 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13764 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13765 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13766
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013767 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013768 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13769 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13770 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13771 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13772
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013773 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13774 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13775 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13776 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013777
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013778 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13779 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13780 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013781
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013782crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013784 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013785 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013786 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013787
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013788crt-list <file>
13789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013790 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13791 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013792
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013793 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13794
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013795 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13796 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13797 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13798 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13799 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013800
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013801 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013802 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13803 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13804 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13805 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13806 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013807 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13808 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13809 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013810
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013811 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13812 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13813 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013814
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013815 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13816
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013817 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013818 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013819 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13820 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13821 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13822 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13823 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13824 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013825
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013826 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013827 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013828 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013829 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013830 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013831 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013832
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013833defer-accept
13834 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13835 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13836 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013837 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013838 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13839 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13840 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13841 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13842 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13843 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13844 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13845
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013846expose-fd listeners
13847 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13848 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010013849 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
13850 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013851 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013852
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013853force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013854 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013855 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013856 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013857 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013858
13859force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013860 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013861 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013862 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013863
13864force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013865 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013866 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013867 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013868
13869force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013870 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013871 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013872 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013873
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013874force-tlsv13
13875 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13876 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013877 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013878
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013879generate-certificates
13880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13881 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13882 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13883 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13884 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13885 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13886 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13887 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13888 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13889 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13890 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13891
13892 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13893 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013894 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013895 certificate is used many times.
13896
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013897gid <gid>
13898 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13899 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13900 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13901 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13902 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13903
13904group <group>
13905 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13906 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13907 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13908 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13909 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13910
13911id <id>
13912 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13913 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13914 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13915 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13916
13917interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013918 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13919 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13920 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13921 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13922 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13923 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013924 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13925 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13926 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13927 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13928 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13929 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013930
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013931level <level>
13932 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13933 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13934 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013935 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013936 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13937 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13938 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013939 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013940 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013941 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013942 all counters).
13943
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013944severity-output <format>
13945 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13946 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13947 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13948 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13949 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13950 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13951 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13952 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13953 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13954 rfc5424 convention.
13955
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013956maxconn <maxconn>
13957 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13958 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13959 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13960 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13961 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13962 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13963 eat all memory.
13964
13965mode <mode>
13966 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13967 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13968 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13969 UNIX sockets.
13970
13971mss <maxseg>
13972 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13973 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13974 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13975 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13976 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13977 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13978 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13979 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13980 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13981 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13982 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13983
13984name <name>
13985 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13986 page.
13987
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013988namespace <name>
13989 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13990 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13991 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13992 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13993
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013994nice <nice>
13995 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13996 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13997 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13998 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13999 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14000 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14001 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14002 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14003 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14004 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14005 one for an RDP socket.
14006
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014007no-ca-names
14008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14009 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014010 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014011
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014012no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014013 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014014 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014015 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014016 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014017 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14018 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014019
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014020no-tls-tickets
14021 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14022 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14023 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014024 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14025 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014026 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14027 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14028 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014029
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014030no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014032 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014033 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014034 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014035 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14036 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014037
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014038no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014039 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014040 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014041 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014042 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014043 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14044 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014045
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014046no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014048 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014049 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014050 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014051 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14052 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014053
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014054no-tlsv13
14055 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14056 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14057 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14058 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014059 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14060 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014061
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014062npn <protocols>
14063 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14064 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14065 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014066 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014067 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014068 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14069 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14070 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14071 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14072 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014073
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014074prefer-client-ciphers
14075 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14076 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14077 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014078 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14079 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14080 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014081
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014082process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014083 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14084 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
14085 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
14086 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14087 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14088 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014089
14090 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14091
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014092 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014093 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14094 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14095 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14096 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14097 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014098
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014099 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14100 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14101
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014102proto <name>
14103 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14104 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14105 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014106 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14107 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14108
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014109 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14110 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14111 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014112
14113 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14114 a bind line :
14115
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014116 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014117 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14118 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14119
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014120 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014121 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014122 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014123 h2" on the bind line.
14124
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014125shards <number> | by-thread
14126 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14127 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14128 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14129 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14130 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14131 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14132 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14133 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14134 little bit.
14135
14136 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14137 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14138 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14139 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14140 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14141 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14142
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014143ssl
14144 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014145 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014146 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14147 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014148 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14149 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014150
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014151ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14152 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014153 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14154 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14155 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014156 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14157
14158ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014159 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14160 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14161 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14162 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014163
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014164strict-sni
14165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14166 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14167 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14168 See the "crt" option for more information.
14169
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014170tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014171 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014172 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014173 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014174 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014175 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14176 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14177 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14178 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14179 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14180 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14181 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14182
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014183tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014184 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014185 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14186 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14187 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14188 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14189 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14190 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14191 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014192 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14193 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14194 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014195
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014196thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014197 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14198 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14199 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014200
14201 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14202 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14203 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14204 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14205 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14206 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14207 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14208 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14209 of the parsing.
14210
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014211 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014212 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14213 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014214
14215 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14216
14217 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14218 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14219 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14220 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14221 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14222 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14223
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014224tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14225 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014226 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14227 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14228 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14229 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14230 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14231 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14232 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14233 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14234 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14235 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014236 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14237 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14238
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014239transparent
14240 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14241 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14242 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14243 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14244 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14245 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14246 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14247 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14248 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14249 so check for support with your vendor.
14250
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014251v4v6
14252 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14253 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14254 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14255 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014256 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014257
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014258v6only
14259 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14260 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14261 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014262 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14263 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014264
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014265uid <uid>
14266 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14267 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14268 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14269 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14270 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14271
14272user <user>
14273 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14274 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14275 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14276 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14277 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14278
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014279verify [none|optional|required]
14280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14281 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14282 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14283 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14284 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014285 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14286 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14287 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14288 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014289
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200142905.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014291------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014293The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14294which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14295arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14296settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14297after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14298Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14299address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014301 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014302 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014303
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014304Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14305keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014307The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014308
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014309addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014310 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014311 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14312 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14313 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14314 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14315 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014316
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014317agent-check
14318 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014319 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014320 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14321 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14322 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014323
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014324 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014325 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014326 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014327 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14328 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014329
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014330 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14331 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14332 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14333 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14334 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014335
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014336 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014337 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014338
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014339 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14340 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14341 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014342
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014343 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14344 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14345 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014346
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014347 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014348 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14349 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14350 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14351 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014352 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014353 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014354
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014355 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14356 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014357
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014358 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14359 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14360 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14361 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14362 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14363 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14364 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14365 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14366 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014367
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014368 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14369 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014370 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14371 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14372 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014373 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014374
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014375 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014376 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014377
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014378agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014379 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014380 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14381 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14382 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14383 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14384
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014385agent-inter <delay>
14386 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14387 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14388
14389 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14390 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14391 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14392 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14393 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14394 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14395 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14396 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14397 of backends use the same servers.
14398
14399 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14400
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014401agent-addr <addr>
14402 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14403
14404 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014405 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014406 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14407 hostname, it will be resolved.
14408
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014409agent-port <port>
14410 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14411
14412 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14413
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014414allow-0rtt
14415 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014416 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14417 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014418
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014419alpn <protocols>
14420 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14421 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14422 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014423 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014424 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14425 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14426 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14427 now obsolete NPN extension.
14428 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14429 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14430
14431 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14432
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014433 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014435backup
14436 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14437 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14438 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14439 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014440 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14441 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014442
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014443ca-file <cafile>
14444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14445 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014446 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14447 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
14448 .crl" available in the directory.
14449
14450 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
14451 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
14452 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014454check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014455 This option enables health checks on a server:
14456 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14457 considered available.
14458 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14459 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14460 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14461 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14462 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014463 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
14464 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014465 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14466 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14467 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14468 exchanges succeed.
14469
14470 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14471 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14472 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14473 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14474 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014475 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014476 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14477
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014478 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
14479 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitely
14480 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
14481 not overridden.
14482
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014483 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14484 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14485
14486 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14487 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14488
14489 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14490 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14491 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14492 available.
14493
14494 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14495 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14496 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14497
14498 Example:
14499 # simple tcp check
14500 backend foo
14501 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14502 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14503 backend foo
14504 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14505 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14506 backend foo
14507 option tcp-check
14508 tcp-check connect
14509 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014510
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014511check-send-proxy
14512 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14513 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14514 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14515 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14516 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14517 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14518 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14519
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014520check-alpn <protocols>
14521 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14522 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14523 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14524
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014525check-proto <name>
14526 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14527 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14528 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014529 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14530 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14531
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014532 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14533 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14534 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014535
14536 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14537 directive on a server line:
14538
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014539 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014540 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14541 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14542 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14543
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014544 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014545 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14546 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14547
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014548check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014549 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014550 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14551 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014552
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014553check-ssl
14554 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14555 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14556 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14557 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014558 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014559 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14560 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014561 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014562 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14563 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014564
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014565check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014566 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014567 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14568 for normal traffic.
14569
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014570ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14572 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14573 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014574 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14575 information and recommendations see e.g.
14576 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14577 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14578 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014579
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014580ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14582 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14583 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14584 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014585 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14586 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14587 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014589cookie <value>
14590 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14591 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14592 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14593 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14594 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14595 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14596 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14597
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014598crl-file <crlfile>
14599 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14600 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14601 to verify server's certificate.
14602
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014603crt <cert>
14604 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14605 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14606 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14607 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14608 certificate request.
14609
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014610 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14611 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14612 option is set accordingly).
14613
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014614disabled
14615 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14616 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14617 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14618 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14619 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014620 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014621
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014622enabled
14623 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14624 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14625 default value.
14626 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14627 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014628
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014629error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014630 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14631 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14632 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014633
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014634 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014636fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014637 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14638 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14639 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14640
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014641force-sslv3
14642 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14643 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014644 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014645 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014646
14647force-tlsv10
14648 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014649 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014650 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014651
14652force-tlsv11
14653 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014654 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014655 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014656
14657force-tlsv12
14658 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014659 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014660 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014661
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014662force-tlsv13
14663 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14664 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014665 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014667id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014668 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14669 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14670 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014671
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014672init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14673 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14674 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014675 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014676 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14677 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14678 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14679 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14680 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14681 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14682 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14683 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14684 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014685 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014686 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14687 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14688 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14689 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14690 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14691 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014692 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014693
14694 Example:
14695 defaults
14696 # never fail on address resolution
14697 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014699inter <delay>
14700fastinter <delay>
14701downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014702 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14703 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14704 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14705 between checks depending on the server state :
14706
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014707 Server state | Interval used
14708 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14709 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14710 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14711 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14712 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14713 or yet unchecked. |
14714 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14715 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14716 | "inter" otherwise.
14717 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014719 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14720 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14721 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14722 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014723 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14724 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14725 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14726 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14727 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014728
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014729log-proto <logproto>
14730 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14731 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14732 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14733 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014735maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014736 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14737 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014738 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14739 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014740 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14741 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14742 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14743 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14744
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014745 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14746 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14747 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14748 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14749 than 50 concurrent requests.
14750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014751maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014752 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14753 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14754 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14755 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014756 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14757 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14758 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14759 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14760 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14761 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14762 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014763
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014764max-reuse <count>
14765 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14766 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14767 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14768 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14769 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14770 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14771 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14772 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014774minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014775 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14776 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14777 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14778 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14779 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14780 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014781 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014782 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014783
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014784namespace <name>
14785 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14786 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14787 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14788 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14789
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014790no-agent-check
14791 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14792 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14793 default value.
14794 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14795 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14796
14797no-backup
14798 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14799 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14800 default value.
14801 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14802 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14803
14804no-check
14805 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14806 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14807 default value.
14808 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14809 "default-server" "check" setting.
14810
14811no-check-ssl
14812 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14813 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14814 default value.
14815 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14816 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14817
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014818no-send-proxy
14819 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14820 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14821 default value.
14822 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14823 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14824
14825no-send-proxy-v2
14826 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14827 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14828 default value.
14829 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14830 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14831
14832no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14833 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14834 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14835 default value.
14836 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14837 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14838
14839no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14840 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14841 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14842 default value.
14843 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14844 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14845
14846no-ssl
14847 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14848 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14849 default value.
14850 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14851 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14852
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014853 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14854 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14855 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14856
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014857no-ssl-reuse
14858 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14859 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14860 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14861 and for paranoid users.
14862
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014863no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014864 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14865 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014866 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014867
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014868 Supported in default-server: No
14869
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014870no-tls-tickets
14871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14872 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14873 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014874 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14875 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014876 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14877 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14878 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014879 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014880
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014881no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014882 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014883 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14884 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014885 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14886 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014887 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014888
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014889 Supported in default-server: No
14890
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014891no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014892 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014893 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14894 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014895 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14896 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014897 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014898
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014899 Supported in default-server: No
14900
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014901no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014902 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014903 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14904 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014905 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14906 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014907 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014908
14909 Supported in default-server: No
14910
14911no-tlsv13
14912 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14913 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14914 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14915 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14916 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014917 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014918
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014919 Supported in default-server: No
14920
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014921no-verifyhost
14922 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14923 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14924 default value.
14925 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14926 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014927
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014928no-tfo
14929 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14930 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14931 default value.
14932 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14933 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14934
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014935non-stick
14936 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14937 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14938 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14939
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014940npn <protocols>
14941 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14942 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14943 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014944 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014945 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14946 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14947 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014949observe <mode>
14950 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14951 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14952 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14953 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14954 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14955 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014956 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014957
14958 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014960on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014961 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14962 Currently, four modes are available:
14963 - fastinter: force fastinter
14964 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14965 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14966 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14967 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14968
14969 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14970
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014971on-marked-down <action>
14972 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14973 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014974 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14975 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14976 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14977 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14978 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14979 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14980 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14981 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014982
14983 Actions are disabled by default
14984
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014985on-marked-up <action>
14986 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14987 Currently one action is available:
14988 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14989 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14990 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14991 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014992 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14993 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014994 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14995 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14996
14997 Actions are disabled by default
14998
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014999pool-low-conn <max>
15000 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15001 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15002 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15003 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15004 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15005 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15006 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15007 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15008 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15009 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015010 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15011 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15012 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15013 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015014
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015015pool-max-conn <max>
15016 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15017 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15018 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15019 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15020 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15021 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15022
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015023pool-purge-delay <delay>
15024 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015025 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015026 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015028port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015029 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015030 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15031 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15032 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15033 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15034 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015035
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015036proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015037 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15038 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15039 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015040 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15041 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15042
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015043 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15044 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15045 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015046
15047 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15048 a server line :
15049
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015050 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015051 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15052 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15053 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15054
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015055 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015056 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15057
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015058 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015060redir <prefix>
15061 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15062 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15063 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15064 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15065 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15066 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15067 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15068 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015069 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015070 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015071 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15072 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15073 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15074 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15075
15076 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015078rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015079 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15080 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15081 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15082
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015083resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15084 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15085 server.
15086
15087 Available options:
15088
15089 * allow-dup-ip
15090 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15091 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15092 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15093 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15094 For such case, simply enable this option.
15095 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15096
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015097 * ignore-weight
15098 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15099 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15100 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15101
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015102 * prevent-dup-ip
15103 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15104 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15105 same fqdn.
15106 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15107
15108 Example:
15109 backend b_myapp
15110 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15111 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15112 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15113
15114 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15115 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15116 it
15117 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15118 different address
15119
15120 Default value: not set
15121
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015122resolve-prefer <family>
15123 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15124 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15125 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15126 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15127
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015128 Default value: ipv6
15129
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015130 Example:
15131
15132 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015133
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015134resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015135 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015136 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015137 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015138 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15139 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015140 configured network, another address is selected.
15141
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015142 Example:
15143
15144 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015145
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015146resolvers <id>
15147 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15148 hostname.
15149
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015150 Example:
15151
15152 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015153
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015154 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015155
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015156send-proxy
15157 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15158 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15159 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15160 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015161 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15162 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15163 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15164 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015165 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015166 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15167 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15168 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15169 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15170 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015171 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15172 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015173
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015174send-proxy-v2
15175 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15176 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15177 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15178 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015179 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15180 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15181 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15182 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015183
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015184proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015185 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15186 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15187
15188 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15189 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15190 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15191 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15192 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15193 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15194 connection is supported).
15195 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15196 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15197 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15198 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15199 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15200 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15201 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015202
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015203send-proxy-v2-ssl
15204 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15205 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15206 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15207 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15208 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15209 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15210 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015211 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15212 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015213
15214send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15215 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15216 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15217 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15218 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15219 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15220 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15221 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15222 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015223 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15224 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015226slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015227 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15228 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15229 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15230 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15231 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15232 parameters :
15233
15234 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15235 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15236
15237 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15238 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15239 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15240 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15241
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015242 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015243 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15244 seen as failed.
15245
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015246sni <expression>
15247 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15248 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15249 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15250 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015251 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15252 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015253 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015254 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15255 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015256
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015257source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015258source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015259source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015260 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15261 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15262 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15263 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15264
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015265 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15266 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15267 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15268 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15269 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15270 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15271 server.
15272
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015273 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15274 specifying the source address without port(s).
15275
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015276ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015277 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15278 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15279 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15280 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15281 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15282 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015283 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15284 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015285
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015286ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15287 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15288 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15289 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15290
15291ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15292 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15293 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15294 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15295
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015296ssl-reuse
15297 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15298 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15299 default value.
15300 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15301 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15302
15303stick
15304 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15305 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15306 default value.
15307 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15308 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015309
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015310socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015311 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015312 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15313 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15314
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015315tcp-ut <delay>
15316 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015317 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015318 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015319 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015320 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15321 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15322 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15323 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15324 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15325 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15326 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15327 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15328 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15329
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015330tfo
15331 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15332 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15333 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15334 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015335 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015336 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015338track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015339 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15340 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15341 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15342 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015343 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15344
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015345tls-tickets
15346 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15347 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15348 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015349 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15350 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15351 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015352 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015353 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015354
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015355verify [none|required]
15356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015357 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015358 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15359 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015360 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015361 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15362 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15363 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15364 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15365 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15366 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15367 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15368 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015369
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015370verifyhost <hostname>
15371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015372 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15373 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15374 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15375 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15376 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15377 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15378 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15379 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015381weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015382 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15383 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15384 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015385 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15386 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15387 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15388 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15389 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15390 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015391
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015392ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15393 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15394 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15395 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15396
15397 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15398 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15399 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15400 server ALPN contains it.
15401
15402 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15403 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15404 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15405 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15406
15407 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15408 favor of the ALPN extension.
15409
15410 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015412
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200154135.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15414-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015415
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015416HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15417using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015418configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015419This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15420can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15421workload.
15422This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15423resolution at run time.
15424Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15425carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15426
15427
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200154285.3.1. Global overview
15429----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015430
15431As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15432different steps of the process life:
15433
15434 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15435 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15436 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15437
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015438 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15439 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015440
15441A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15442 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15443 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15444 resolution to know this new IP.
15445
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015446When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015447HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015448SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15449from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015450will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015451will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015452
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015453A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015454 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015455 first valid response.
15456
15457 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15458 servers return an error.
15459
15460
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200154615.3.2. The resolvers section
15462----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015463
15464This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015465HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15466contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015467
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015468When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15469uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15470is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15471answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15472
15473When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015474used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015475
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015476 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15477 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15478 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015479
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015480 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15481 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015482
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015483 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015484 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15485 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015486
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015487For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15488following scenarios are possible:
15489
15490 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15491 ignored
15492
15493 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15494 applied
15495
15496 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15497 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15498
15499 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15500 retries the query with a new type
15501
15502 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15503 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015504
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015505As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015506a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015507<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015508
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015509
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015510resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015511 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015512
15513A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15514
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015515accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015516 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015517 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015518 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15519 by RFC 6891)
15520
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015521 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15522 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15523 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15524 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15525 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15526 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015527
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015528nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15529 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15530 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15531 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15532 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15533 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15534 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15535 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15536 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15537 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015538 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15539
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015540parse-resolv-conf
15541 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15542 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15543 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15544
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015545hold <status> <period>
15546 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15547 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015548 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015549 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015550 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15551 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15552 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15553
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015554 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015555
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015556resolve_retries <nb>
15557 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15558 giving up.
15559 Default value: 3
15560
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015561 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15562 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15563 type.
15564
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015565timeout <event> <time>
15566 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15567 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15568 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015569 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15570 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015571 Default value: 1s
15572 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015573 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015574 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015575 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15576 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15577
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015578 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015579
15580 resolvers mydns
15581 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15582 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015583 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015584 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015585 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015586 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015587 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015588 hold other 30s
15589 hold refused 30s
15590 hold nx 30s
15591 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015592 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015593 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015594
15595
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200155966. Cache
15597---------
15598
15599HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15600(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15601RAM.
15602
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015603The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15604blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015605
15606If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15607independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15608when we try to allocate a new one.
15609
15610The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15611
15612It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15613"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15614for more details.
15615
15616When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15617replaced by "<CACHE>".
15618
15619
156206.1. Limitation
15621----------------
15622
15623The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15624
15625- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015626- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15627 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15628 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015629- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15630- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015631- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15632 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15633 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015634- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15635 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015636- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15637 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15638 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015639
15640- If the request is not a GET
15641- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15642- If the request contains an Authorization header
15643
15644
156456.2. Setup
15646-----------
15647
15648To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15649the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15650
15651
156526.2.1. Cache section
15653---------------------
15654
15655cache <name>
15656 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15657 size of cache is mandatory.
15658
15659total-max-size <megabytes>
15660 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15661 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15662
15663max-object-size <bytes>
15664 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15665 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15666 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15667
15668max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015669 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015670 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15671 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15672 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15673 default.
15674
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015675process-vary <on/off>
15676 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015677 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15678 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15679 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015680 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015681
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015682max-secondary-entries <number>
15683 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15684 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15685 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15686
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015687
156886.2.2. Proxy section
15689---------------------
15690
15691http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15692 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15693 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15694 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15695 after this one.
15696
15697http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15698 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15699 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15700 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15701 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15702
15703
15704Example:
15705
15706 backend bck1
15707 mode http
15708
15709 http-request cache-use foobar
15710 http-response cache-store foobar
15711 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15712
15713 cache foobar
15714 total-max-size 4
15715 max-age 240
15716
15717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157187. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15719----------------------------------
15720
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015721HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15723The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15724these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15725but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15726data called patterns.
15727
15728
157297.1. ACL basics
15730---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015731
15732The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15733content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15734from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15735simple :
15736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015738 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15740 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15743adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015744
15745In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015748
15749This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15750Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15751and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015752an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15753conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15754as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15755are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015756
15757ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15758'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15759which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15760
15761There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15762performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015764The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15765specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15766this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015767methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15768ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769
15770Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15771 - boolean
15772 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15773 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15774 - string
15775 - data block
15776
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015777Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15778converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15779would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15780The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15781which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15782
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015783Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15784keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15785fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15786which are summarized in the table below :
15787
15788 +---------------------+-----------------+
15789 | Sample or converter | Default |
15790 | output type | matching method |
15791 +---------------------+-----------------+
15792 | boolean | bool |
15793 +---------------------+-----------------+
15794 | integer | int |
15795 +---------------------+-----------------+
15796 | ip | ip |
15797 +---------------------+-----------------+
15798 | string | str |
15799 +---------------------+-----------------+
15800 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15801 +---------------------+-----------------+
15802
15803Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15804matching method, see below.
15805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015806The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15807 - boolean
15808 - integer or integer range
15809 - IP address / network
15810 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15811 - regular expression
15812 - hex block
15813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015814The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15815
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015816 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15817 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015819 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015820 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015821 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015822 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015824The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15825read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15826if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15827lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15828will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15829beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015830a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15832exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15833
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015834The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15835parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15836ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15837a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15838check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15839
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015840The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15841socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15842file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15845loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15846
15847 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15848
15849In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15850the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15851case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15852as well.
15853
15854The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15855sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15856do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15857methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15858is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015859obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015860followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15861default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15862that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15863string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15864
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015865The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15866By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15867string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15868resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015869server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015870waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015871flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15872function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15875sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15876be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015877
15878 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15879 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15881 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15882 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15883 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015884
15885 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15886 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015888
15889 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015891
15892 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015894
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015895 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015896 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15897
15898 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15899 binary or string samples.
15900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015901 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15902 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15905 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15906 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15909 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15912 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15915 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15918 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015919 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15922 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15923 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015924
15925For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15926request, it is possible to do :
15927
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015928 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015929
15930In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15931buffer, one would use the following acl :
15932
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015933 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015934
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015935On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15936possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15937
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015938 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15941criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15942method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15943to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15944criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15945the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015948the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15949For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15952 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15953 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15954 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015955
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015956
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015957The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15958types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15959combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15960brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15961default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963 +-------------------------------------------------+
15964 | Input sample type |
15965 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015966 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15968 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15969 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015970 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015971 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015972 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015974 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015976 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015978 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015980 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015982 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015983 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015984 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015986 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015988 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015990 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015991 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15992 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15993 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015994
15995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159967.1.1. Matching booleans
15997------------------------
15998
15999In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16000Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16001When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16002that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16003
16004Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16005return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16006"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16007
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160097.1.2. Matching integers
16010------------------------
16011
16012Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16013enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16014to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16015
16016Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16017matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16018lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016019
16020For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16021unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16022representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16023
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016024As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16025two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16026instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16027ranges and operators.
16028
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016029For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016030operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16031Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16032of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016034Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016035
16036 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16037 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16038 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16039 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16040 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16041
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016042For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016043
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016044 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016045
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016046This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16047
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016048 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016049
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160517.1.3. Matching strings
16052-----------------------
16053
16054String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16055different forms :
16056
16057 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016058 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059
16060 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016061 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062
16063 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16064 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16065
16066 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16067 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16068
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010016069 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
16071 matches.
16072
16073 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
16074 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
16075 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016076
16077String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16078exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16079characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16080string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16081to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016082before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016083
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016084Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16085(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16086Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16087
16088Example:
16089 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16090 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16091
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160937.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16094---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016095
16096Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16097they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16098possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16099passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16100the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016101the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16102match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016103
16104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161057.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16106-------------------------------------
16107
16108It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16109not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16110a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16111to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16112digits may be used upper or lower case.
16113
16114Example :
16115 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016116 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016117
16118
161197.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16120---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016121
16122IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16123netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16124within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016125host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016126difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16127at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16128does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16129parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016130
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016131The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16132abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16133
16134 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16135 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16136 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16137 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16138 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16139 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16140 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16141 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16142
16143Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16144192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16145
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016146IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16147Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16148trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16149IPv6 patterns.
16150
16151HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16152following situations :
16153 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16154 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16155 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16156 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16157 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16158 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16159 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16160 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16161 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16162 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164
161657.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16166----------------------------------
16167
16168Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16169combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16170
16171 - AND (implicit)
16172 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16173 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16180indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016182For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16183"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16184requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16185is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16186
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016187 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016188 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16189 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16190 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016191
16192To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16193and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16194
16195 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16196 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16197 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16198 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16199
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016200 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016201 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16202 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16203 use_backend www if host_www
16204
16205It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16206expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16207be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16208the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16209
16210 The following rule :
16211
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016212 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016213 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016214
16215 Can also be written that way :
16216
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016217 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016218
16219It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16220to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16221simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16222sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16223good use is the following :
16224
16225 With named ACLs :
16226
16227 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16228 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16229 monitor fail if site_dead
16230
16231 With anonymous ACLs :
16232
16233 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16234
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016235See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16236keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237
16238
162397.3. Fetching samples
16240---------------------
16241
16242Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16243against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16244sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16245ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16246of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16247available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16248
16249This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16250Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16251compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16252deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16253
16254The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16255matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16256method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16257indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16258
16259As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16260when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16261mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16262the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16263ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16264
16265Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16266multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16267when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016268incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16269are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16271all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16272
16273Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16274 - name
16275 - name(arg1)
16276 - name(arg1,arg2)
16277
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016278
162797.3.1. Converters
16280-----------------
16281
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016282Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16283of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16284is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16285was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016286has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016287unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16288
16289These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16290sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16291the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016292support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016293
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016294A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16295support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16296supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16297(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16298bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016301
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001630251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16303 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16304 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16305 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16306 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16307 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16308
16309 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016310 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16311 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016312 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16313 frontend http-in
16314 bind *:8081
16315 default_backend servers
16316 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16317 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16318
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016319add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016320 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016321 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016322 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16323 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016324 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016325 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16326 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16327 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16328 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016329 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016330 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016331
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020016332add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
16333 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
16334 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
16335 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
16336 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
16337 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16338 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
16339 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
16340 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
16341 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
16342 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
16343 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
16344 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
16345 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
16346 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
16347 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
16348 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
16349 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16350 level parser. See examples below.
16351
16352 Example:
16353 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
16354 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
16355 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
16356 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
16357
16358 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
16359 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
16360
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016361aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16362 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16363 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16364 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16365 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16366 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16367 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16368
16369 Example:
16370 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16371 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16372
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016373and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016374 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016375 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016376 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16377 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016378 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016379 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16380 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16381 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16382 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016383 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016384 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016385
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016386b64dec
16387 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16388 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016389 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16390 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016391
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016392base64
16393 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016394 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016395 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16396 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016397
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016398be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16399 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16400 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16401 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16402 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16403 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16404
16405 Example:
16406 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16407 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16408 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16409 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16410
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016411be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16412 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16413 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16414 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16415 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16416 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16417 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16418
16419 Example:
16420 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16421 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16422 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16423 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16424
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016425bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016426 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016427 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016428 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016429 presence of a flag).
16430
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016431bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16432 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16433 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016434 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016435
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016436concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16437 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16438 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16439 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16440 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16441 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16442 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16443 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16444 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16445 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16446 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016447 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016448 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016449 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016450 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16451 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16452 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016453
16454 Example:
16455 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16456 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16457 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016458 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016459 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016460 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16461
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016462cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016463 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16464 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016465
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016466crc32([<avalanche>])
16467 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16468 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16469 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16470 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16471 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16472 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16473 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16474 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16475 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16476 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016477 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16478
16479crc32c([<avalanche>])
16480 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16481 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16482 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16483 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16484 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16485 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16486 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16487 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016488
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016489cut_crlf
16490 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16491 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16492 updated.
16493
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016494da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016495 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16496 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16497 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16498 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016499 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016500 configuration language.
16501
16502 Example:
16503 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016504 bind *:8881
16505 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016506 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016507
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016508debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16509 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16510 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16511 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16512 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16513 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16514 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16515 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16516 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16517 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16518 printable sample types.
16519
16520 Example:
16521 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016522
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016523digest(<algorithm>)
16524 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16525 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16526
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016527 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016528 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16529
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016530div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016531 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16532 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016533 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016534 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16535 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016536 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016537 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16538 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16539 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16540 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016541 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016542 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016543
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016544djb2([<avalanche>])
16545 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16546 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16547 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16548 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16549 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16550 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16551 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016552 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16553 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016554
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016555even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016556 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016557 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16558
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016559field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16560 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16561 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16562 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16563 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16564 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16565 fields.
16566
16567 Example :
16568 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16569 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16570 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16571 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16572 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016573
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016574fix_is_valid
16575 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16576 Information eXchange):
16577
16578 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16579 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016580 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016581 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016582 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016583 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16584 checksum
16585
16586 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16587 the server can be parsed.
16588
16589 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16590 message, false if not.
16591
16592 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16593
16594 Example:
16595 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16596 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16597
16598fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16599 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16600 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16601 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16602 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016603 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016604 added.
16605
16606 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16607 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16608 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16609 fix_is_valid converter.
16610
16611 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16612
16613 Example:
16614 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16615 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16616 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16617 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16618 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16619
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016620hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016621 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016622 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016623 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016624 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016625
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016626hex2i
16627 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016628 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016629
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016630htonl
16631 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16632 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16633 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16634 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16635
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016636hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016637 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16638 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16639 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16640 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16641
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016642 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016643 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16644
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016645http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016646 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16647 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016648 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16649 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16650 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16651 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16652 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16653 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16654 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16655 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016657iif(<true>,<false>)
16658 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16659 string otherwise.
16660
16661 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016662 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016663
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016664in_table(<table>)
16665 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16666 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16667 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016668 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016669 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16670
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016671ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016672 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016673 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016674 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16675 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16676 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16677 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16678 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016679
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016680json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016681 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016682 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016683 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016684 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16685 of errors:
16686 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16687 bytes, ...)
16688 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16689 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16690
16691 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16692 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16693 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16694 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16695 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16696 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016697 - "ascii" : never fails;
16698 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16699 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016700 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016701 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016702 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16703 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16704
16705 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016706 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016707
16708 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016709 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016710 capture request header user-agent len 150
16711 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016712
16713 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16714 GET / HTTP/1.0
16715 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16716
16717 Output log:
16718 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16719
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016720json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16721 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16722 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16723 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16724 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16725
16726 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16727 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16728
16729 Example:
16730 # get a integer value from the request body
16731 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16732 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16733
16734 # get a key with '.' in the name
16735 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16736 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16737
16738 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16739 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16740
16741 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16742 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16743
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020016744jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16745 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
16746 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
16747 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
16748 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16749 json_path and output_type parameters.
16750
16751 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16752 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16753
16754jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16755 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
16756 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
16757 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
16758 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16759 json_path and output_type parameters.
16760
16761 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16762 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16763
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016764jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
16765 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
16766 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016767 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016768 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
16769 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
16770 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
16771 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016772
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016773 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
16774 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
16775 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
16776 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016777
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016778 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
16779 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
16780 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
16781 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
16782 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
16783 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016784 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016785 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
16786
16787 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
16788 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
16789 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
16790 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
16791 contents.
16792
16793 The possible return values are the following :
16794
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016795 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
16796 | ID | message |
16797 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016798 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016799 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016800 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
16801 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
16802 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
16803 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
16804 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016805 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016806
16807 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16808 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16809
16810 Example:
16811 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
16812 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
16813 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
16814 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
16815 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
16816 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
16817
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016818language(<value>[,<default>])
16819 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16820 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16821 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16822 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16823 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16824 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16825 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16826 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16827 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016828 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016829 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16830 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016831
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016832 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016833
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016834 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16835 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016836
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016837 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16838 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16839 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16840 use_backend spanish if es
16841 use_backend french if fr
16842 use_backend english if en
16843 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016844
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016845length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016846 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16847 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16848 type. The result is of type integer.
16849
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016850lower
16851 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16852 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16853 type. The result is of type string.
16854
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016855ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16856 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16857 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16858 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16859 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16860 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16861 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16862
16863 Example :
16864
16865 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016866 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016867 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16868
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016869ltrim(<chars>)
16870 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16871 representation of the input sample.
16872
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016873map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16874map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16875map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16876 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16877 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16878 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16879 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16880 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16881 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16882 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16883 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016884
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016885 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16886 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16887 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016888
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016889 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016890 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016891
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016892 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16893 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16894 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16895 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016896 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16897 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016898 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16899 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16900 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16901 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16902 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16903 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16904 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16905 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016906 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16907 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16908 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016909 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16910 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16911 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16912 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16913 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016914
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016915 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16916 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16917 the corresponding match text.
16918
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016919 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16920 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16921 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16922 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16923 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016924
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016925 Example :
16926
16927 # this is a comment and is ignored
16928 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16929 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16930 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16931 | | | `---------- value
16932 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16933 | `---------------------------- key
16934 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16935
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016936mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016937 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16938 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016939 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016940 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016941 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016942 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16943 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16944 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16945 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016946 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016947 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016948
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016949mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016950 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16951 <packettype>.
16952 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16953 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16954 from.
16955 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16956 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16957 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16958
16959 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16960 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16961 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16962 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16963
16964 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16965 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16966 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16967 packets only):
16968 17: Session Expiry Interval
16969 33: Receive Maximum
16970 39: Maximum Packet Size
16971 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16972 25: Request Response Information
16973 23: Request Problem Information
16974 21: Authentication Method
16975 22: Authentication Data
16976 18: Will Delay Interval
16977 1: Payload Format Indicator
16978 2: Message Expiry Interval
16979 3: Content Type
16980 8: Response Topic
16981 9: Correlation Data
16982 Not supported yet:
16983 38: User Property
16984
16985 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16986 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16987 packets only):
16988 17: Session Expiry Interval
16989 33: Receive Maximum
16990 36: Maximum QoS
16991 37: Retain Available
16992 39: Maximum Packet Size
16993 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16994 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16995 31: Reason String
16996 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16997 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16998 42: Shared Subscription Available
16999 19: Server Keep Alive
17000 26: Response Information
17001 28: Server Reference
17002 21: Authentication Method
17003 22: Authentication Data
17004 Not supported yet:
17005 38: User Property
17006
17007 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17008 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17009 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17010 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17011
17012 Example:
17013
17014 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
17015 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17016 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
17017 if data_in_buffer
17018 # do the same as above
17019 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17020 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
17021 if data_in_buffer
17022
17023mqtt_is_valid
17024 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
17025
17026 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17027 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17028 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17029 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17030
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010017031 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
17032
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017033 Example:
17034
17035 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040017036 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017037
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017038mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017039 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020017040 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
17041 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017042 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017043 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017044 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017045 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17046 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17047 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17048 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017049 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017050 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017051
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010017052nbsrv
17053 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
17054 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
17055 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
17056 map lookup.
17057
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017058neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017059 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
17060 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
17061 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
17062 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017063
17064not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017065 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017066 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017067 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017068 absence of a flag).
17069
17070odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017071 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017072 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
17073
17074or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017075 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017076 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017077 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17078 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017079 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017080 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17081 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17082 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17083 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017084 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017085 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017086
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017087protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
17088 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
17089 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
17090 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
17091 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
17092 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17093 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17094 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17095 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
17096 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
17097 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17098 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
17099
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010017100regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017101 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
17102 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
17103 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17104 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17105 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17106 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17107 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17108 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17109 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017110 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17111 of characters with other ones.
17112
17113 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17114 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17115 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17116 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17117 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17118 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017119
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017120 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017121
17122 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17123 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17124 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017125 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017126
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017127 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17128 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17129
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017130 # capture groups and backreferences
17131 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017132 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017133 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17134
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017135capture-req(<id>)
17136 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17137 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17138
17139 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017140 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17141 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017142
17143capture-res(<id>)
17144 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17145 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17146
17147 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017148 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17149 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017150
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017151rtrim(<chars>)
17152 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17153 of the input sample.
17154
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017155sdbm([<avalanche>])
17156 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17157 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17158 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17159 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17160 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17161 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17162 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017163 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17164 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017165
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017166secure_memcmp(<var>)
17167 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17168 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17169 match.
17170
17171 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17172 performed in constant time.
17173
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017174 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017175 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17176
17177 Example :
17178
17179 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17180 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17181 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17182 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17183
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017184set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017185 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017186 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17187 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17188 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17189 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017190 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017191 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17192 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017193 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017194 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17195 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017196 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017197 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017198
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017199 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17200 possible conditions :
17201 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
17202 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
17203 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
17204 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
17205 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
17206 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
17207 Checks if the input is empty or not.
17208 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
17209 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
17210 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
17211 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
17212 called on the variable.
17213 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
17214 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
17215 configuration parsing.
17216 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
17217 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
17218 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
17219 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
17220 true by default.
17221
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017222sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017223 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017224 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17225
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017226sha2([<bits>])
17227 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17228 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17229
17230 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17231 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17232
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017233 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017234 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17235
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017236srv_queue
17237 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17238 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17239 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17240 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17241 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17242
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017243strcmp(<var>)
17244 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17245 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17246 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17247 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17248 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17249 shorter).
17250
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017251 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17252 strings in constant time.
17253
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017254 Example :
17255
17256 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17257 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17258 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17259
17260
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017261sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017262 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17263 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017264 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017265 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17266 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017267 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017268 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17269 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017270 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017271 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17272 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017273 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017274 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017275
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017276table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17277 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17278 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17279 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17280 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17281 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17282 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17283
17284
17285table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17286 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17287 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17288 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17289 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17290 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17291 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17292
17293table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17294 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17295 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017296 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017297 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17298 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17299
17300table_conn_cur(<table>)
17301 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17302 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17303 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17304 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17305 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17306
17307table_conn_rate(<table>)
17308 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17309 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17310 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17311 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17312 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17313
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017314table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17315 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17316 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17317 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17318 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17319 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17320 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17321 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17322 data-type).
17323 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17324
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017325table_gpt0(<table>)
17326 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17327 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17328 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17329 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17330 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17331
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017332table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17333 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17334 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17335 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17336 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17337 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17338 between 0 and 99.
17339 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17340 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17341 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17342 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17343
17344table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17345 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17346 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17347 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17348 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17349 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17350 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17351 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17352 value 0.
17353 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17354 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17355 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17356
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017357table_gpc0(<table>)
17358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17360 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17361 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17362 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17363
17364table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17365 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17366 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17367 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17368 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17369 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17370 sample fetch keyword.
17371
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017372table_gpc1(<table>)
17373 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17374 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17375 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17376 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17377 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17378
17379table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17380 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17381 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17382 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17383 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17384 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17385 sample fetch keyword.
17386
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017387table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17388 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17389 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017390 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017391 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17392 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17393
17394table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17395 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17396 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17397 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17398 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17399 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17400 keyword.
17401
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017402table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17403 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17404 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17405 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17406 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17407 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17408
17409table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17410 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17411 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17412 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17413 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17414 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17415 keyword.
17416
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017417table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17418 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17419 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017420 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017421 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17422 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17423
17424table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17425 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17426 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17427 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17428 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17429 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17430 keyword.
17431
17432table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17433 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17434 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017435 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017436 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17437 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17438 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17439 keyword.
17440
17441table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17442 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17443 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017444 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017445 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17446 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17447 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17448 keyword.
17449
17450table_server_id(<table>)
17451 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17452 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17453 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17454 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17455 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17456 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17457
17458table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17459 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17460 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017461 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017462 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17463 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17464 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17465 keyword.
17466
17467table_sess_rate(<table>)
17468 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17469 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17470 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17471 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17472 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17473 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17474 keyword.
17475
17476table_trackers(<table>)
17477 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17478 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17479 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17480 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17481 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17482 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17483 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17484 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17485 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17486 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17487
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017488ub64dec
17489 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17490 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17491 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17492
17493 Example:
17494 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17495 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17496
17497ub64enc
17498 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17499
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017500upper
17501 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17502 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17503 type. The result is of type string.
17504
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017505url_dec([<in_form>])
17506 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17507 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17508 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17509 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17510 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17511 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017512
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017513url_enc([<enc_type>])
17514 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17515 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17516 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17517 optional argument is here for future changes.
17518
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017519ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017520 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017521 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17522 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17523 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017524 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17525 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17526 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17527 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017528 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017529 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17530 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017531
17532 Example:
17533 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17534 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17535
17536 message Point {
17537 int32 latitude = 1;
17538 int32 longitude = 2;
17539 }
17540
17541 message PPoint {
17542 Point point = 59;
17543 }
17544
17545 message Rectangle {
17546 // One corner of the rectangle.
17547 PPoint lo = 48;
17548 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17549 PPoint hi = 49;
17550 }
17551
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017552 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17553 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17554 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017555
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017556 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17557 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017558 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017559 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17560
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017561 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017562
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017563 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017564
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017565 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17566 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17567 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017568
17569 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17570 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17571 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17572
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017573 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17574 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17575 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017576
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017577
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017578unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017579 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17580 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17581 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17582 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17583 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17584 response),
17585 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17586 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17587 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17588 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17589
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017590utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17591 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17592 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17593 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17594 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17595 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17596 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17597
17598 Example :
17599
17600 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017601 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017602 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17603
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017604word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17605 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17606 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17607 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017608 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017609 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17610 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17611
17612 Example :
17613 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17614 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17615 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17616 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17617 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017618 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017619
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017620wt6([<avalanche>])
17621 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17622 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17623 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17624 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17625 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17626 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17627 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017628 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17629 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017630
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017631xor(<value>)
17632 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017633 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017634 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017635 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017636 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017637 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17638 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017639 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017640 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17641 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017642 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017643 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017644
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017645xxh3([<seed>])
17646 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17647 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17648 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17649 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17650 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17651 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17652 considered as cryptographically secure.
17653
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017654xxh32([<seed>])
17655 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17656 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17657 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17658 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17659 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17660 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17661 as cryptographically secure.
17662
17663xxh64([<seed>])
17664 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17665 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17666 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17667 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17668 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17669 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17670 as cryptographically secure.
17671
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017672
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017674--------------------------------------------
17675
17676A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17677not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17678"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17679The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17680
17681always_false : boolean
17682 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17683 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17684
17685always_true : boolean
17686 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17687 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17688
17689avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017690 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017691 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17692 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17693 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17694 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17695 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17696 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17697 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17698 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17699 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17700 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17701 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17702 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17703 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017705be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017706 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17707 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17708 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17709 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017710 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17711
17712be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17713 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17714 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17715 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17716 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17717 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017718 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17719 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017720
17721 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17722 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17723 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017725be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17726 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17727 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17728 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017729 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17731 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017732
17733 Example :
17734 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17735 backend dynamic
17736 mode http
17737 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17738 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017739
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017740bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017741 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17742 of the string.
17743
17744bool(<bool>) : bool
17745 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17746 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017748connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17749 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017750 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017751 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17752 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017753
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017754 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017755 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017756 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17757
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017758 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17759 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017760
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017761 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017762 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017763 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017764 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017765 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017766 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017767 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017768
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017769 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17770 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017771 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017772 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017773
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017774cpu_calls : integer
17775 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17776 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17777 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17778 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17779 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17780 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17781
17782cpu_ns_avg : integer
17783 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17784 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17785 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17786 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17787 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17788 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17789 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17790 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17791 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17792 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17793 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17794
17795cpu_ns_tot : integer
17796 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17797 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17798 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17799 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17800 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17801 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17802 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17803 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17804 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17805 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17806 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17807 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17808 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17809
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017810date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017811 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017812
17813 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17814 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17815 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017816 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17817
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017818 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17819 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17820 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17821 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17822 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17823
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017824 Example :
17825
17826 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17827 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017828
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017829 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17830 # millisecond granularity
17831 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17832
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017833date_us : integer
17834 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17835 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17836 from the same timeval structure.
17837
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017838env(<name>) : string
17839 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17840 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17841 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17842 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17843 certain way.
17844
17845 Examples :
17846 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17847 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17848
17849 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017850 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017852fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17853 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017854 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17855 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017856 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17857 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017858 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017859 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17860 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017861
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017862fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17863 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17864 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17865 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17868 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17869 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17870 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17871 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17872 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17873 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17874 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17875 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017876
17877 Example :
17878 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17879 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17880 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17881 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17882 frontend mail
17883 bind :25
17884 mode tcp
17885 maxconn 100
17886 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17887 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17888 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17889 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017890
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017891hostname : string
17892 Returns the system hostname.
17893
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017894int(<integer>) : signed integer
17895 Returns a signed integer.
17896
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017897ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17898 Returns an ipv4.
17899
17900ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17901 Returns an ipv6.
17902
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010017903last_rule_file: string
17904 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
17905 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
17906 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
17907 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
17908 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
17909 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
17910 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
17911 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
17912 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
17913 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
17914 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
17915 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
17916
17917last_rule_line: integer
17918 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
17919 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
17920 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
17921 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
17922 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
17923 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
17924 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
17925 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
17926 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
17927 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
17928 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
17929 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
17930
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017931lat_ns_avg : integer
17932 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17933 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17934 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17935 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17936 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17937 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17938 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17939 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17940 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017941 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17942 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17943 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17944 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17945 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17946 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017947
17948lat_ns_tot : integer
17949 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17950 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17951 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17952 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17953 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17954 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17955 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17956 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17957 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017958 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17959 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17960 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17961 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17962 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017963 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17964 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17965 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17966 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17967 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17968 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17969
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017970meth(<method>) : method
17971 Returns a method.
17972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017973nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17974 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17975 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17976 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017977 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17978 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17979 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017980
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017981prio_class : integer
17982 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17983 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17984 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17985
17986prio_offset : integer
17987 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17988 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17989 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17990 set-priority-offset".
17991
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017992proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017993 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17994 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017996queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017997 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17998 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17999 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018000 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
18001 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
18002 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
18003 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
18004 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
18005
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010018006rand([<range>]) : integer
18007 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
18008 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
18009 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
18010 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
18011 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
18012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018013srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18014 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18015 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
18016 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
18017 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
18018 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018019 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
18020 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
18021
18022srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18023 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18024 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
18025 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18026 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
18027 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
18028 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
18029 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
18030
18031 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
18032 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018033
18034srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
18035 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
18036 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
18037 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018038 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018039 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
18040 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
18041 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
18042
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020018043srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18044 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
18045 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18046 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
18047 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
18048 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
18049 fetch methods.
18050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018051srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18052 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18053 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018054 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018055 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
18056 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018057 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018058 overloading servers).
18059
18060 Example :
18061 # Redirect to a separate back
18062 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
18063 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
18064 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
18065
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018066srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018067 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
18068 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
18069 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
18070
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018071srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018072 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
18073 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18074 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
18075
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018076srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018077 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
18078 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18079 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
18080
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018081stopping : boolean
18082 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
18083 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
18084 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
18085
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018086str(<string>) : string
18087 Returns a string.
18088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018089table_avl([<table>]) : integer
18090 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
18091 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
18092
18093table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18094 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
18095 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
18096 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
18097
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010018098thread : integer
18099 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
18100 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
18101 and debugging purposes.
18102
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020018103uuid([<version>]) : string
18104 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
18105 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18106 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18107
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018108var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018109 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018110 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18111 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18112 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018113 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018114 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18115 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018116 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018117 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18118 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018119 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018120 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018121
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200181227.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018123----------------------------------
18124
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018125The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018126closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18127methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18128sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18129TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018130the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18131counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018132"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
18133used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
18134can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
18135Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
18136table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18137tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18138currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018139
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018140bc_dst : ip
18141 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18142 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18143 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18144 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18145
18146bc_dst_port : integer
18147 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018148 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018149
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018150bc_err : integer
18151 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18152 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18153 and their corresponding error message.
18154
18155bc_err_str : string
18156 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18157 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18158 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18159 corresponding error message.
18160
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018161bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018162 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18163 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18164 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18165
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018166bc_src : ip
18167 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018168 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018169 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18170 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18171
18172bc_src_port : integer
18173 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018174 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018176be_id : integer
18177 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018178 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18179 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018180
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018181be_name : string
18182 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018183 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18184 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018185
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018186be_server_timeout : integer
18187 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18188 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18189 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18190
18191be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18192 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18193 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18194 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18195
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018196cur_server_timeout : integer
18197 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18198 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18199 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18200
18201cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18202 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18203 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18204 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018206dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018207 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18208 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18209 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18210 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18211 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18212 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18213 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18214 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18215 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18216 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18217 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218
18219dst_conn : integer
18220 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18221 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18222 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18223 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18224 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18225 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18226 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18227 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018228
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018229dst_is_local : boolean
18230 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18231 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18232 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18233 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018234 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018235 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18236 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18237 it only once per connection.
18238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018239dst_port : integer
18240 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18241 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018242 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18243 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18244 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18245 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018246
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018247fc_dst : ip
18248 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18249 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18250 for details.
18251
18252fc_dst_is_local : boolean
18253 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
18254 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
18255 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
18256
18257fc_dst_port : integer
18258 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
18259 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
18260 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
18261
18262fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018263 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18264 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18265 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018266 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018267 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18268
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018269fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018270 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018271 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018272 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018273 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18274
18275 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18276 | ID | message |
18277 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18278 | 0 | "Success" |
18279 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18280 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18281 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18282 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18283 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18284 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18285 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18286 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18287 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18288 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18289 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18290 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18291 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18292 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18293 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18294 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18295 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18296 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18297 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18298 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18299 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18300 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18301 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18302 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18303 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18304 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18305 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18306 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18307 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18308 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18309 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18310 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18311 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18312 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18313 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18314 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18315 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18316 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18317 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18318 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18319 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18320 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018321 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018322 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18323
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018324fc_fackets : integer
18325 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18326 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18327 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18328 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18329
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018330fc_http_major : integer
18331 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18332 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18333 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18334
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018335fc_lost : integer
18336 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18337 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18338 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18339 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18340
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018341fc_pp_authority : string
18342 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18343 if any.
18344
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018345fc_pp_unique_id : string
18346 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18347 if any.
18348
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018349fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18350 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18351 header.
18352
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018353fc_reordering : integer
18354 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18355 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18356 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18357 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18358
18359fc_retrans : integer
18360 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18361 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18362 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18363 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18364
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018365fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18366 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18367 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18368 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18369 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18370 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18371 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18372
18373fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18374 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18375 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18376 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18377 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18378 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18379 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18380
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018381fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018382 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18383 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18384 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18385 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18386
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018387fc_src : ip
18388 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18389 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
18390 for details.
18391
18392fc_src_is_local : boolean
18393 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
18394 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
18395 "src_is_local" for details.
18396
18397fc_src_port : integer
18398
18399 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18400 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
18401 this address. See "src-port" for details.
18402
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018403
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018404fc_unacked : integer
18405 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18406 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18407 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18408 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018409
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018410fe_defbe : string
18411 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18412 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018414fe_id : integer
18415 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018416 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018417 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18418
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018419fe_name : string
18420 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18421 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18422 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18423
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018424fe_client_timeout : integer
18425 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18426 current frontend.
18427
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018428sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018429sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18430sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18431sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018432 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18433 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18434 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018436sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018437sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18438sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18439sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018440 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18441 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18442 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18443
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018444sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18445 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18446 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18447 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18448 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18449 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18450 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18451 will always return zero.
18452 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18453 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18454
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018455sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018456sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18457sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18458sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018459 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18460 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018461 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18462 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18463 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018464
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018465 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018466 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18467 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018468 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18469 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18470 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018471 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18472 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18473
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018474sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18475sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18476sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18477sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18478 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18479 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18480 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18481 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18482 when a first ACL was verified.
18483
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018484sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018485sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18486sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18487sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018488 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018489 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18490
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018491sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018492sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18493sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18494sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018495 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18496 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18497 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018499sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018500sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18501sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18502sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018503 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18504 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18505 See also src_conn_rate.
18506
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018507sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18508 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18509 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18510 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18511 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18512 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18513 index, zero is returned.
18514 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18515 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18516
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018517sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018518sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18519sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18520sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018521 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018522 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018523
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018524sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18525sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18526sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18527sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18528 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18529 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18530
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018531sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18532 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18533 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18534 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18535 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18536 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18537 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18538 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18539
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018540sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18541sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18542sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18543sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18544 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18545 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18546
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018547sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18548 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18549 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18550 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18551 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18552 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18553 between 0 and 2.
18554 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18555 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18556 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18557 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18558 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18559
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018560sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018561sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18562sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18563sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018564 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18565 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18566 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018567 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18568 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18569 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018570
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018571sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18572sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18573sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18574sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18575 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18576 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18577 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18578 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18579 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18580 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18581
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018582sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018583sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18584sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18585sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018586 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018587 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18588 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18589
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018590sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018591sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18592sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18593sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018594 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18595 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18596 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18597 src_http_err_rate.
18598
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018599sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18600sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18601sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18602sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18603 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18604 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18605 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18606
18607sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18608sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18609sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18610sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18611 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18612 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18613 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18614 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18615
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018616sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018617sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18618sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18619sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018620 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018621 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18622 src_http_req_cnt.
18623
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018624sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018625sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18626sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18627sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018628 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18629 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18630 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18631 src_http_req_rate.
18632
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018633sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18634 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18635 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18636 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18637 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18638 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18639 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18640 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18641 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18642 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18643
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018644sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018645sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18646sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18647sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018648 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018649 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18650 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18651 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18652 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018653
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018654 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018655 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18656 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018657 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18658
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018659sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18660sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18661sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18662sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18663 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18664 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18665 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18666 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18667 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018669sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018670sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18671sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18672sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018673 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18674 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18675 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018676
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018677sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018678sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18679sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18680sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018681 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18682 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18683 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018684
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018685sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018686sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18687sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18688sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018689 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018690 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18691 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18692 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018693 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018694 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18695
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018696sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018697sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18698sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18699sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018700 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18701 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18702 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18703 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18704 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018705 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018706
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018707sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018708sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18709sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18710sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018711 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18712 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18713 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18714
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018715sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018716sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18717sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18718sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018719 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18720 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018721 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018722 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18723 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018724 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18725 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18726 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018728so_id : integer
18729 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18730 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18731 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018732
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018733so_name : string
18734 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18735 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18736 strings instead of integers.
18737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018738src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018739 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
18740 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
18741 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18742 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
18743 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
18744 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
18745 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
18746 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
18747 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
18748 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
18749 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
18750 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
18751 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
18752 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
18753 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018754
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018755 Example:
18756 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18757 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18760 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18761 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18762 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018763 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018765src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18766 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18767 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018768 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018769 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018770
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018771src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18772 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18773 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18774 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18775 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18776 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18777 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18778 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18779 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018781src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18782 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18783 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18784 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18785 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18786 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18787 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018788
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018789 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018790 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18791 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18792 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18793 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018794 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018795 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18796 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18797
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018798src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18799 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18800 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18801 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18802 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18803 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18804 was verified.
18805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018807 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018808 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018809 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018810 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018812src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018813 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018814 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18815 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018816 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018818src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18819 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18820 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18821 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018822 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018823
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018824src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18825 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18826 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18827 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18828 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18829 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18830 is returned.
18831 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18832 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18833 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018835src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018836 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018838 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018839 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018840
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018841src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18842 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18843 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18844 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18845 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18846
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018847src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18848 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18849 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18850 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18851 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18852 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18853 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18854
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018855src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18856 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18857 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18858 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18859 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18860
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018861src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18862 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18863 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18864 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18865 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18866 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18867 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18868 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18869 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18870 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18871 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018873src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018874 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018875 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018876 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18877 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018878 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18879 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18880 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018881
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018882src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18883 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18884 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18885 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18886 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18887 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18888 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18889 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018891src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018892 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018893 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018894 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018895 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018896 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018898src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18899 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18900 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18901 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18902 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018903 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018904
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018905src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18906 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18907 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018908 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018909 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18910 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18911
18912src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18913 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18914 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18915 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18916 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18917 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18918 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018920src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018921 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018922 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18923 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018924 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018926src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18927 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18928 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18929 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018930 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018931 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018932
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018933src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18934 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18935 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18936 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18937 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18938 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18939 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18940 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18941 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018943src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18944 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18945 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18946 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018947 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018948 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18949 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018950
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018951 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018952 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018953 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018954 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018955
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018956src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18957 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18958 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18959 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18960 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18961 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18962 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18963
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018964src_is_local : boolean
18965 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18966 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18967 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18968 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018969 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018970 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18971 once per connection.
18972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018973src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018974 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18975 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18976 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18977 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18978 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018980src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018981 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18982 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18983 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18984 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18985 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987src_port : integer
18988 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018989 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
18990 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
18991 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
18992 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018994src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018995 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018996 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18997 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18998 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018999 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019001src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19002 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
19003 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19004 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19005 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019006 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019008src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19009 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
19010 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
19011 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
19012 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
19013 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
19014 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
19015 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
19016 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019017
19018 Example :
19019 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
19020 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
19021 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
19022 listen ssh
19023 bind :22
19024 mode tcp
19025 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019026 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019027 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019028 server local 127.0.0.1:22
19029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019030srv_id : integer
19031 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
19032 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019033 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020019034
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019035srv_name : string
19036 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
19037 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019038 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019039
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190407.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019041----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020019042
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019043The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019044closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
19045when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
19046usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019047future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019048
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001904951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
19050 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
19051 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
19052 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
19053 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
19054 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
19055
19056 Example :
19057 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
19058 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
19059 # the request.
19060 frontend http-in
19061 bind *:8081
19062 default_backend servers
19063 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
19064 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
19065
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019066ssl_bc : boolean
19067 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19068 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019069 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19070 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019071
19072ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
19073 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019074 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19075 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019076
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019077ssl_bc_alpn : string
19078 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
19079 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019080 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019081 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19082 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19083 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
19084 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
19085 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019086 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
19087 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019088
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019089ssl_bc_cipher : string
19090 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019091 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19092 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019093
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019094ssl_bc_client_random : binary
19095 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19096 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19097 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019098 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019099
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019100ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019101 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019102 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19103 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
19104 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
19105 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019106 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19107 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19108 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19109
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019110ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019111 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019112 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19113 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19114 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019115
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019116ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19117 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19118 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019119 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19120 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019121
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019122ssl_bc_npn : string
19123 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19124 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019125 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019126 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19127 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19128 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19129 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019130 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19131 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019132
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019133ssl_bc_protocol : string
19134 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019135 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19136 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019137
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019138ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019139 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019140 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019141 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19142 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019143
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019144ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19145 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19146 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19147 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019148 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019149
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019150ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19151 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19152 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019153 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19154 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019155
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019156ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19157 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19158 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19159 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019160 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019161
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019162ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19163 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019164 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19165 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019167ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19168 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19169 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19170 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19171 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19172 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019174ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19175 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19176 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19177 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19178 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019179
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019180ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019181 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19182 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19183 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019184 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019185 does not support resumed sessions.
19186
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019187ssl_c_der : binary
19188 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19189 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19190 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019192ssl_c_err : integer
19193 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19194 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19195 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19196 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19197 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019198
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019199ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019200 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19201 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19202 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19203 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19204 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19205 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19206 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19207 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019208 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19209 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19210 LDAP v3.
19211 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19212 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019214ssl_c_key_alg : string
19215 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19216 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19217 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019219ssl_c_notafter : string
19220 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19221 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19222 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019224ssl_c_notbefore : string
19225 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19226 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19227 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019228
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019229ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019230 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19231 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19232 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19233 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19234 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19235 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19236 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19237 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019238 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19239 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19240 LDAP v3.
19241 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19242 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019244ssl_c_serial : binary
19245 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19246 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19247 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019249ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19250 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19251 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19252 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019253 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19254 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19255
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019256 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019257 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019259ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19260 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19261 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19262 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019264ssl_c_used : boolean
19265 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19266 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268ssl_c_verify : integer
19269 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19270 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19271 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19272 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019274ssl_c_version : integer
19275 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19276 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019277
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019278ssl_f_der : binary
19279 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19280 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19281 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19282
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019283ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019284 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19285 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19286 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19287 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019288 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019289 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19290 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19291 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019292 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19293 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19294 LDAP v3.
19295 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19296 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019298ssl_f_key_alg : string
19299 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19300 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19301 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019303ssl_f_notafter : string
19304 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19305 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19306 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019308ssl_f_notbefore : string
19309 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19310 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19311 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019312
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019313ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019314 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19315 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19316 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19317 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19318 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19319 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19320 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19321 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019322 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19323 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19324 LDAP v3.
19325 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19326 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019328ssl_f_serial : binary
19329 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19330 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19331 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019332
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019333ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19334 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19335 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19336 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019338ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19339 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19340 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19341 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019343ssl_f_version : integer
19344 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19345 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19346
19347ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019348 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19349 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19350 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019352 Example :
19353 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19354 listen http-https
19355 bind :80
19356 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19357 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19358
19359ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19360 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19361 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19362
19363ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019364 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019365 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019366 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019367 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19368 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19369 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19370 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19371 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19372 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019374ssl_fc_cipher : string
19375 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19376 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019377
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019378ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19379 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19380 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019381 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019382 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19383 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19384 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019385
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019386 Example:
19387 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19388 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19389 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19390 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19391 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19392 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19393 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19394 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19395 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19396
19397ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019398 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019399 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019400 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19401 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019402 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19403 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019404
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019405ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019406 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019407 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019408 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019409 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19410 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19411 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19412 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19413 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19414 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019415
19416ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019417 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019418 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19419 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019420
19421ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19422 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19423 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019424 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019425
19426 Example:
19427 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19428 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19429 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19430 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19431 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19432 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19433 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19434 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19435 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19436
19437ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19438 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19439 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019440 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019441 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19442 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19443 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19444
19445 Example:
19446 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19447 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19448 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19449 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19450 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19451 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19452 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19453 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19454 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19455
19456ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19457 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19458 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019459 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019460 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19461 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19462 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19463
19464 Example:
19465 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19466 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19467 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19468 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19469 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19470 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19471 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19472 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19473 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019474
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019475ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19476 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19477 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19478 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19479
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019480ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19481 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19482 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19483 transport layer.
19484 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19485 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19486 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19487 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19488
19489ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19490 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19491 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19492 transport layer.
19493 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19494 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19495 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19496 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19497
19498ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19499 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19500 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19501 transport layer.
19502 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19503 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19504 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19505 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19506
19507ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19508 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19509 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19510 transport layer.
19511 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19512 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19513 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19514 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19515
19516ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19517 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19518 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19519 transport layer.
19520 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19521 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19522 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19523 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19524
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019525ssl_fc_err : integer
19526 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19527 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19528 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19529 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19530 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19531 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19532 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19533 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19534 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19535 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19536 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19537 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19538 codes.
19539
19540ssl_fc_err_str : string
19541 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19542 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19543 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19544 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19545 also "ssl_fc_err".
19546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019547ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019548 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19549 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019550 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19551 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19552 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19553 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019554
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019555ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19556 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19557 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19558 wait until the handshake happened.
19559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019560ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19561 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019562 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19563 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019564 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019565 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019566
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019567ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019568 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019569 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19570 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019572ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019573 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019574 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019575 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19576 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19577 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19578 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19579 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19580 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019582ssl_fc_protocol : string
19583 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19584 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019585
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019586ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19587 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19588 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019589 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19590 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019591
19592 Example:
19593 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19594 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19595 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19596 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19597 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19598 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19599 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19600 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19601 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19602
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019603ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019604 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019605 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010019606 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019607
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019608ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19609 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19610 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19611 transport layer.
19612 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19613 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19614 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19615 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19616
19617ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19618 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19619 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19620 transport layer.
19621 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19622 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19623 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19624 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19625
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019626ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19627 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19628 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19629 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019631ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19632 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19633 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19634 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19635 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019636
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019637ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19638 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19639 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19640 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19641 BoringSSL.
19642
19643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019644ssl_fc_sni : string
19645 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19646 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019647 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019648 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19649 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19650
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019651 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019652 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019653 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019654 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019655 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019657 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019658 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19659 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019661ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19662 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19663 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019664
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019665ssl_s_der : binary
19666 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19667 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19668 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19669
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019670ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19671 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19672 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19673 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019674 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019675 does not support resumed sessions.
19676
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019677ssl_s_key_alg : string
19678 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19679 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19680 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19681
19682ssl_s_notafter : string
19683 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19684 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19685 transport layer.
19686
19687ssl_s_notbefore : string
19688 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19689 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19690 transport layer.
19691
19692ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19693 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19694 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19695 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19696 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19697 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19698 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019699 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19700 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019701 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19702 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19703 LDAP v3.
19704 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19705 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19706
19707ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19708 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19709 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19710 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19711 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19712 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19713 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019714 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19715 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019716 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19717 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19718 LDAP v3.
19719 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19720 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19721
19722ssl_s_serial : binary
19723 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19724 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19725 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19726
19727ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19728 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19729 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19730 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19731
19732ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19733 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19734 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19735 layer.
19736
19737ssl_s_version : integer
19738 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19739 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019740
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200197417.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019742------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019744Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19745sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19746only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19747For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19748be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19749can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19750sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19751for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19752content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019753
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019754Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19755 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019756 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019757 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19758 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19759 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19760 sample expression). So be careful.
19761
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010019762distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
19763 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
19764 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
19765 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
19766 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
19767 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
19768 list of supported tokens.
19769
19770distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
19771 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
19772 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
19773 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
19774 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
19775 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
19776 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
19777 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
19778 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
19779 supported tokens.
19780
19781 Example :
19782 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
19783 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
19784 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
19785 # send large files to the big farm
19786 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
19787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019788payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019789 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019790 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19791 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019793payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19794 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019795 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019796 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019798req.len : integer
19799req_len : integer (deprecated)
19800 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19801 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19802 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19803 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19804 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019805 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019806 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19807 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019809req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19810 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019811 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19812 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19813 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19814 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019815
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019816 ACL derivatives :
19817 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019819req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19820 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19821 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19822 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19823 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019824
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019825 ACL derivatives :
19826 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019828 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019830req.proto_http : boolean
19831req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19832 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19833 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19834 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19835 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19836 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19837 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19838 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019840 Example:
19841 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19842 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19843 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019844 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019846req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19847rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19848 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19849 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19850 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19851 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19852 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19853 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19854 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019856 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19857 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19858 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19859 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19860 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19861 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019863 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019864 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019866 Example :
19867 listen tse-farm
19868 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19869 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19870 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19871 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19872 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19873 persist rdp-cookie
19874 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19875 # This is only useful makes sense if
19876 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19877 stick-table type string size 204800
19878 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19879 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19880 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019882 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019883 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019885req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19886rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19887 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19888 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19889 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19890 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019892 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019893 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019894
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019895req.ssl_alpn : string
19896 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19897 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19898 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19899 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19900 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19901 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019902 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019903
19904 Examples :
19905 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19906 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019907 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019908 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019909 default_backend bk_default
19910
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019911req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19912 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19913 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019914 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19915 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19916 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19917 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19918 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019920req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19921req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19922 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19923 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19924 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19925 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19926 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19927 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19928 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019930req.ssl_sni : string
19931req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19932 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19933 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19934 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19935 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19936 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019937 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19938 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19939 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19940 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19941 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19942 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19943 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19944 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19945 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019947 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019948 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019950 Examples :
19951 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19952 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019953 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019954 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019955 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019956
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019957req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19958 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19959 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19960 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19961 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19962 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19963 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19964 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19965 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19966 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019968req.ssl_ver : integer
19969req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19970 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19971 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19972 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19973 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19974 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19975 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19976 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019977 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019978 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019980 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019981 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019982
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019983res.len : integer
19984 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19985 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19986 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19987 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19988 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019989 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019990 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019991 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019993res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19994 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019995 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019996 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019997 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019998 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020000res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20001 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20002 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20003 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020004 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
20005 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020007 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020008
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020020009res.ssl_hello_type : integer
20010rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20011 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20012 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
20013 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20014 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20015 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
20016 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20017 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
20018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020019wait_end : boolean
20020 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
20021 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020022 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020023 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
20024 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020025 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020026 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
20027 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020029 Examples :
20030 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
20031 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
20032 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020034 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
20035 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20036 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
20037 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
20038 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
20039 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
20040 tcp-request content reject
20041
20042
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200200437.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020044--------------------------------------
20045
20046It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
20047This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
20048data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
20049its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
20050HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
20051content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
20052to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
20053more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
20054response are indexed.
20055
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010020056Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
20057 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
20058 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
20059 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
20060 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
20061 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
20062 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
20063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020064base : string
20065 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20066 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
20067 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
20068 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
20069 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
20070 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
20071 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
20072 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
20073
20074 ACL derivatives :
20075 base : exact string match
20076 base_beg : prefix match
20077 base_dir : subdir match
20078 base_dom : domain match
20079 base_end : suffix match
20080 base_len : length match
20081 base_reg : regex match
20082 base_sub : substring match
20083
20084base32 : integer
20085 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
20086 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
20087 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020020088 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
20089 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
20090 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020091
20092base32+src : binary
20093 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
20094 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
20095 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
20096 per-URL counters.
20097
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010020098baseq : string
20099 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20100 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
20101 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
20102 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
20103
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020104capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
20105 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
20106 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20107 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
20108
20109capture.req.method : string
20110 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
20111 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
20112 because it's allocated.
20113
20114capture.req.uri : string
20115 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
20116 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
20117 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
20118 allocated.
20119
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020120capture.req.ver : string
20121 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20122 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
20123 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
20124
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020125capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
20126 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
20127 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20128 The first entry is an index of 0.
20129 See also: "capture response header"
20130
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020131capture.res.ver : string
20132 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20133 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20134 persistent flag.
20135
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020136req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020137 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20138 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20139 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020140
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020141req.body_param([<name>) : string
20142 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20143 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20144 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20145 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20146 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20147 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20148 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20149 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20150 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20151 given.
20152
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020153req.body_len : integer
20154 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
20155 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020156 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
20157 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020158
20159req.body_size : integer
20160 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020161 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20162 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020164req.cook([<name>]) : string
20165cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20166 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20167 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
20168 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
20169 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
20170 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
20171 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
20172 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
20173 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
20174
20175 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020176 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
20177 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
20178 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
20179 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
20180 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
20181 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
20182 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
20183 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020185req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20186cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20187 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20188 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020190req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20191cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20192 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20193 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20194 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20195 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020197cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20198 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20199 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20200 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20201 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020202 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020203 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20204 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20205 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20206 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020208hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20209 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20210 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20211 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20212 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020213 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020215req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020216 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20217 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20218 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20219 with headers such as User-Agent.
20220
20221 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20222 found.
20223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020224 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20225 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20226 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020227 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020229req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20230 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20231 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020232 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20233 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020235req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020236 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20237 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20238 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20239 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20240 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20241 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20242 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20243
20244 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20245 found.
20246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020247 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20248 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20249 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020250 with -1 being the last one.
20251
20252 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20253 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020255 ACL derivatives :
20256 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20257 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20258 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20259 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20260 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20261 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20262 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20263 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20264
20265req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20266hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20267 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20268 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020269 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20270 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20271 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20272
20273 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20274 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20275 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20276
20277 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020278
20279req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20280hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20281 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20282 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20283 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020284 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20285 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20286 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20287 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20288 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020289
20290 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20291
20292 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020293
20294req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20295hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20296 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20297 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20298 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020299
20300 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20301
20302 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020303
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020304req.hdrs : string
20305 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20306 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20307 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20308 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20309
20310req.hdrs_bin : binary
20311 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20312 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20313 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20314 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20315 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20316 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20317
20318 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020319
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020320 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20321 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020323http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20324 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20325 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20326 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20327 basic auth is supported.
20328
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020329http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20330 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20331 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20332 performed on the data sent by the client.
20333 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20334 Authorization one.
20335
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020336http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20337 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20338 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20339 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20340 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020341 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20342 basic auth is supported.
20343
20344 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020345 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20346 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20347 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20348 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020349
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020350http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020351 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20352 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20353 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020354
20355http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020356 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20357 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20358 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020359
20360http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020361 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20362 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20363 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020365http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020366 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20367 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020368 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20369 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020371method : integer + string
20372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20373 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20374 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20375 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20376 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20377 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20378 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020380 ACL derivatives :
20381 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020383 Example :
20384 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20385 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20386 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020388path : string
20389 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20390 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20391 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20392 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20393 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020394 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020395 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020397 ACL derivatives :
20398 path : exact string match
20399 path_beg : prefix match
20400 path_dir : subdir match
20401 path_dom : domain match
20402 path_end : suffix match
20403 path_len : length match
20404 path_reg : regex match
20405 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020406
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020407pathq : string
20408 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20409 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20410 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20411 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20412 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20413 result in both cases.
20414
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020415query : string
20416 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20417 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20418 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20419 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020420 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020421 which stops before the question mark.
20422
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020423req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20424 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20425 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20426 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20427 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020429req.ver : string
20430req_ver : string (deprecated)
20431 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20432 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20433 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020435 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020436 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020437
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020438res.body : binary
20439 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20440 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020441 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20442
20443 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020444
20445res.body_len : integer
20446 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20447 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020448 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20449
20450 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020451
20452res.body_size : integer
20453 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20454 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20455 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20456 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020457 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20458
20459 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020460
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020461res.cache_hit : boolean
20462 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20463 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20464
20465res.cache_name : string
20466 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20467 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20468 empty string.
20469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020470res.comp : boolean
20471 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20472 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20473 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020475res.comp_algo : string
20476 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20477 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20478 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020480res.cook([<name>]) : string
20481scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20482 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20483 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020484 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20485
20486 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020488 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020489 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020491res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20492scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20493 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20494 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020495 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20496
20497 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020499res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20500scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20501 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20502 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020503 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20504
20505 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020507res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020508 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20509 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20510
20511 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20512 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20513
20514 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20515
20516 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020518res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020519 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20520 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20521
20522 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20523 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20524
20525 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020527res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20528shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020529 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20530 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20531
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020532 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020533 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20534
20535 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020537 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020538 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20539 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20540 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20541 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20542 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20543 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20544 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20545 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020546
20547res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20548shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020549 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20550 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20551
20552 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020553 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020554
20555 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020557res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20558shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020559 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20560 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20561
20562 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20563
20564 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020565
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020566res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20567 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20568 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20569 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020570 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20571
20572 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020574res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20575shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020576 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20577 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20578
20579 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20580
20581 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020582
20583res.hdrs : string
20584 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20585 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20586 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020587 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20588
20589 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020590
20591res.hdrs_bin : binary
20592 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20593 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20594 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20595 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20596 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20597 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20598 (length of 0 for both).
20599
20600 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20601
20602 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20603 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020605res.ver : string
20606resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20607 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020608 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20609
20610 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020612 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020613 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020615set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20616 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20617 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020618 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020619 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020621 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20622 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020624status : integer
20625 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20626 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020627 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20628
20629 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020630
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020631unique-id : string
20632 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20633 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20634 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20635 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20636 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20637 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020639url : string
20640 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20641 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20642 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20643 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20644 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20645 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20646 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020648 ACL derivatives :
20649 url : exact string match
20650 url_beg : prefix match
20651 url_dir : subdir match
20652 url_dom : domain match
20653 url_end : suffix match
20654 url_len : length match
20655 url_reg : regex match
20656 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020658url_ip : ip
20659 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20660 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20661 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20662 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020663 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20664 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020666url_port : integer
20667 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020668 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020669
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020670urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20671url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020672 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20673 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020674 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20675 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20676 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20677 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020678 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20679 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020680 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20681 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020683 ACL derivatives :
20684 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20685 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20686 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20687 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20688 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20689 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20690 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20691 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020692
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020694 Example :
20695 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20696 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20697 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20698 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020699
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020700urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020701 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20702 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20703 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020704
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020705url32 : integer
20706 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20707 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20708 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20709 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20710 is an unsigned integer.
20711
20712url32+src : binary
20713 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20714 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20715 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20716
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020717
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200207187.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020719---------------------------------------
20720
20721This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20722used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20723purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20724There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20725or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20726any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20727for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20728
20729internal.htx.data : integer
20730 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20731 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20732
20733internal.htx.free : integer
20734 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20735 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20736
20737internal.htx.free_data : integer
20738 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20739 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20740
20741internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020742 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20743 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20744 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020745
20746internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20747 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20748 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20749
20750internal.htx.size : integer
20751 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20752 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20753
20754internal.htx.used : integer
20755 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20756 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20757 direction.
20758
20759internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20760 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20761 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20762 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20763 of the special value :
20764 * head : The oldest inserted block
20765 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020766 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020767
20768internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20769 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20770 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20771 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20772 integer or one of the special value :
20773 * head : The oldest inserted block
20774 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020775 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020776
20777internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20778 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20779 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20780 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20781 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20782
20783 * head : The oldest inserted block
20784 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020785 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020786
20787internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20788 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20789 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20790 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20791 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20792
20793 * head : The oldest inserted block
20794 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020795 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020796
20797internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20798 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20799 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20800 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20801 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20802
20803 * head : The oldest inserted block
20804 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020805 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020806
20807internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20808 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20809 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20810 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20811 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20812
20813 * head : The oldest inserted block
20814 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020815 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020816
20817internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20818 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20819 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20820 it returns false.
20821
20822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200208237.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020824---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020826Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20827every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020828order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020830ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020831---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20832FALSE always_false never match
20833HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20834HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20835HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020836HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020837HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20838HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20839HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20840HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020020841LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020842METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20843METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20844METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20845METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20846METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20847METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20848METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20849METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20850RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20851REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20852TRUE always_true always match
20853WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20854---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020855
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208578. Logging
20858----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020859
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020860One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20861provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20862very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20863provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20864state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020865to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020866headers.
20867
20868In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20869about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20870send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20871
20872 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20873 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20874 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20875 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20876 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020877 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020878 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020879
20880The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20881allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20882as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20883while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20884real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20885delay.
20886
20887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208888.1. Log levels
20889---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020890
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020891TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020892source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020893HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20894in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20895track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20896syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20897about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020898
20899
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209008.2. Log formats
20901----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020902
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020903HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020904and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20905slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20906options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020907
20908 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20909 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20910 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20911 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20912 extents.
20913
20914 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20915 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20916 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20917 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20918 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20919
20920 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20921 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20922 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20923 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20924 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20925
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020926 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20927 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20928 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20929 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20930
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020931 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20932
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020933Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20934specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20935field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20936servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20937always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20938identifier.
20939
20940Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20941 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20942 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20943 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20944 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20945
20946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209478.2.1. Default log format
20948-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020949
20950This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20951as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20952format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20953
20954 Example :
20955 listen www
20956 mode http
20957 log global
20958 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20959
20960 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20961 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20962 (www/HTTP)
20963
20964 Field Format Extract from the example above
20965 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20966 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20967 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20968 4 'to' to
20969 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20970 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20971
20972Detailed fields description :
20973 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20974 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20975 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20976 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20977 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20978 and processed the connection.
20979 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20980
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020981In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20982"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20983connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20984
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020985It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20986will eventually disappear.
20987
20988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209898.2.2. TCP log format
20990---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020991
20992The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20993is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20994information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20995counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20996emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20997environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20998the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20999sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021000specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021001not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21002
21003The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21004exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021005if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021006
21007 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
21008 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21009 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
21010
21011A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
21012are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021013
21014 Example :
21015 frontend fnt
21016 mode tcp
21017 option tcplog
21018 log global
21019 default_backend bck
21020
21021 backend bck
21022 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21023
21024 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
21025 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
21026 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
21027
21028 Field Format Extract from the example above
21029 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
21030 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
21031 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
21032 4 frontend_name fnt
21033 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
21034 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
21035 7 bytes_read* 212
21036 8 termination_state --
21037 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
21038 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21039
21040Detailed fields description :
21041 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021042 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021043 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21044 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021045 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021046 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021047 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021048
21049 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021050 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21051 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21052 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021053
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021054 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021055 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
21056 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021057 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
21058 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
21059 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
21060 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021061
21062 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21063 and processed the connection.
21064
21065 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21066 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21067 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
21068 applications.
21069
21070 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21071 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21072 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21073 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
21074 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
21075
21076 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21077 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
21078 See "Timers" below for more details.
21079
21080 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21081 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
21082 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
21083 "Timers" below for more details.
21084
21085 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021086 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021087 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
21088 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
21089 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
21090 details.
21091
21092 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
21093 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
21094 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
21095 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
21096 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
21097
21098 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21099 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21100 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
21101 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
21102 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
21103 for more details.
21104
21105 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021106 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021107 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
21108 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
21109 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021110 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021111
21112 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21113 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21114 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21115 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21116 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21117 caused by a denial of service attack.
21118
21119 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21120 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21121 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21122 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21123 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21124 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21125 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21126 denial of service attack.
21127
21128 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21129 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21130 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21131 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21132 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21133 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21134 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21135 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21136 be processed than on other servers.
21137
21138 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21139 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21140 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21141 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021142 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021143 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21144 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21145 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21146 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21147 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21148 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21149 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21150 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21151
21152 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21153 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21154 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21155 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21156 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21157 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021158 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021159 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21160
21161 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21162 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21163 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21164 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21165 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21166 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021167 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021168 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21169 occurs.
21170
21171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211728.2.3. HTTP log format
21173----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021174
21175The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
21176is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
21177the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
21178are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
21179emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
21180generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
21181"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
21182which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021183frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21184is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021185
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021186The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21187exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021188if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021189
21190 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21191 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21192 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21193
21194And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21195this exact string:
21196
21197 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21198 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21199 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21200 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
21201
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021202Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21203slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21204with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21205
21206 Example :
21207 frontend http-in
21208 mode http
21209 option httplog
21210 log global
21211 default_backend bck
21212
21213 backend static
21214 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21215
21216 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21217 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21218 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021219 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021220
21221 Field Format Extract from the example above
21222 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21223 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021224 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021225 4 frontend_name http-in
21226 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021227 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021228 7 status_code 200
21229 8 bytes_read* 2750
21230 9 captured_request_cookie -
21231 10 captured_response_cookie -
21232 11 termination_state ----
21233 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21234 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21235 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21236 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21237 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021238
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021239Detailed fields description :
21240 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021241 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021242 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21243 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021244 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021245 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021246 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021247
21248 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021249 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21250 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21251 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021252
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021253 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021254 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255
21256 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21257 and processed the connection.
21258
21259 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21260 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21261 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21262
21263 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21264 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21265 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21266 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21267 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21268 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21269
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021270 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21271 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21272 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021273 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021274 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21275 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021276 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021277 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021278
21279 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21280 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021281 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021282
21283 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21284 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021285 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21286 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021287
21288 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21289 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21290 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21291 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21292 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021293 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21294 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021295
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021296 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021297 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21298 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21299 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21300 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21301 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21302 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021303 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021304
21305 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021306 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21307 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021308
21309 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21310 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021311 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021312 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21313 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21314 overflowing.
21315
21316 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21317 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21318 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21319 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21320 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21321 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21322 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21323 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21324
21325 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21326 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21327 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21328 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21329 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21330 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21331 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21332 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21333
21334 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21335 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21336 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21337 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21338 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21339 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21340 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21341
21342 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021343 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021344 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21345 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21346 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021347 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021348 system.
21349
21350 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21351 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21352 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21353 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21354 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21355 caused by a denial of service attack.
21356
21357 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21358 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21359 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21360 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21361 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21362 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21363 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21364 denial of service attack.
21365
21366 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21367 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21368 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21369 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21370 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21371 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21372 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21373 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21374 processed than on other servers.
21375
21376 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21377 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21378 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21379 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021380 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021381 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21382 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21383 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21384 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21385 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21386 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21387 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21388 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21389
21390 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21391 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21392 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21393 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21394 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21395 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021396 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021397 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21398
21399 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21400 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21401 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21402 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21403 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21404 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021405 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021406 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21407 occurs.
21408
21409 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21410 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21411 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21412 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21413 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21414 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21415 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21416 cookies" below for more details.
21417
21418 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21419 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21420 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21421 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21422 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21423 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21424 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21425 and cookies" below for more details.
21426
21427 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21428 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21429 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21430 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21431 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21432 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21433 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21434 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21435
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021436
214378.2.4. HTTPS log format
21438----------------------
21439
21440The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21441extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21442information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21443frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21444end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21445matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21446sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21447dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21448"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21449
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021450The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21451exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021452if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021453
21454 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
21455 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21456 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21457 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021458 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021459
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021460This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21461appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21462HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021463
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021464 Example :
21465 frontend https-in
21466 mode http
21467 option httpslog
21468 log global
21469 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21470 default_backend bck
21471
21472 backend static
21473 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21474
21475 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21476 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21477 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021478 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
21479 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021480
21481 Field Format Extract from the example above
21482 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21483 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21484 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21485 4 frontend_name https-in
21486 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21487 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21488 7 status_code 200
21489 8 bytes_read* 2750
21490 9 captured_request_cookie -
21491 10 captured_response_cookie -
21492 11 termination_state ----
21493 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21494 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21495 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21496 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21497 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021498 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021499 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021500 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
21501 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021502
21503Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021504 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
21505 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
21506 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021507
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021508 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21509 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21510 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050021511 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021512 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021513
21514 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21515 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21516 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21517 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21518
21519 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21520 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21521 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21522 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21523
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021524 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21525 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21526 can be shared by multiple requests.
21527
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021528 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
21529 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
21530 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
21531 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
21532 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
21533
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021534 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21535
21536 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21537
21538
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100215398.2.5. Error log format
21540-----------------------
21541
21542When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
21543protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21544unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21545line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21546"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
21547will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
21548logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
21549
21550The default format looks like this :
21551
21552 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21553 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21554 Connection error during SSL handshake
21555
21556 Field Format Extract from the example above
21557 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21558 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21559 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21560 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21561 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21562
21563These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21564failures.
21565
21566By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
21567above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
21568defined format.
21569
21570An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
21571source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
21572number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
21573internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
21574error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
21575the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
21576certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
21577indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
21578indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
21579ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
21580are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
21581would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
21582regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
21583
21584 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010021585 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021586 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
21587 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
21588
21589
215908.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021591------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021592
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021593When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
21594ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
21595a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
21596formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
21597looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
21598and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021599
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021600HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021601Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21602separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21603prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21604
21605Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21606variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021607("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021608
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021609If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021610as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021611less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21612the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21613
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021614Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21615"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21616delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21617preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021618
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021619Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21620'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21621https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21622such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21623
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021624Flags are :
21625 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021626 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021627 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21628 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021629
21630 Example:
21631
21632 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21633 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21634
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021635 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21636
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021637Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21638
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021639 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021640 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021641 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21642 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21643 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021644 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21645 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21646 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021647 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021648 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021649 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021650 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021651 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021652 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21653 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021654 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021655 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021656 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010021657 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021658 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021659 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021660 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021661 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21662 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21663 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21664 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21665 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021666 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021667 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021668 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021669 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021670 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021671 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21672 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021673 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21674 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21675 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021676 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021677 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21678 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021679 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021680 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21681 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21682 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021683 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021684 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021685 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21686 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21687 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21688 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021689 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021690 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021691 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021692 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021693 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021694 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021695 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21696 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21697 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021698 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021699 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21700 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021701 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021702 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21703 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021704 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021705 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021706 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021707 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021708
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021709 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021710
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217128.3. Advanced logging options
21713-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021714
21715Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21716just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21717options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21718for more information about their usage.
21719
21720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217218.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21722------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021723
21724It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021725HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021726commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21727monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21728ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21729
21730 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21731 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21732 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21733 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21734
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021735 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21736 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021737
21738 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21739 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21740 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21741
21742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217438.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21744----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021745
21746The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21747what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21748or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021749"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021750just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21751log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21752after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21753is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21754with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21755with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21756
21757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217588.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21759------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021760
21761Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21762for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21763"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21764retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21765raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21766a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21767file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21768you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21769"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21770
21771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217728.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21773--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021774
21775Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21776multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21777them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21778"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21779logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21780error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21781and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21782too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21783useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21784alternative.
21785
21786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217878.4. Timing events
21788------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021789
21790Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21791reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21792the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21793frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021794mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21795addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21796
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021797Timings events in HTTP mode:
21798
21799 first request 2nd request
21800 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21801 t tr t tr ...
21802 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21803 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21804 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21805 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021806 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021807 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21808
21809Timings events in TCP mode:
21810
21811 TCP session
21812 |<----------------->|
21813 t t
21814 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21815 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21816 |<------ Tt ------->|
21817
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021818 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021819 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021820 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21821 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21822 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021823 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021824 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21825 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21826 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21827 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021828
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021829 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21830 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21831 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021832 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21833 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21834 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21835 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21836 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21837 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021838
21839 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21840 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21841 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21842 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21843 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21844 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21845 request typed by hand during a test.
21846
21847 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21848 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021849 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021850 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21851 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21852 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21853 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021854
21855 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21856 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21857 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21858 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21859 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21860
21861 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21862 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21863 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21864 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21865 connection never established.
21866
21867 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21868 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21869 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21870 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21871 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21872 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21873 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21874 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21875 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21876 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21877 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21878
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021879 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21880 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21881 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21882 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21883 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21884 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21885
21886 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21887
21888 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21889 "Ta" can never be negative.
21890
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021891 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21892 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021893 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21894 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021895 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021896
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021897 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021898
21899 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021900 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21901 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021902
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021903 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21904 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21905 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21906 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21907 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21908 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21909 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21910 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21911
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021912These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21913protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21914that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021915due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21916"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21917that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021918
21919Most common cases :
21920
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021921 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21922 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21923 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21924 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21925 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021926 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021927 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21928 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21929 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21930 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21931 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021932 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021933
21934 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21935 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21936 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21937 of ms on remote networks.
21938
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021939 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21940 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21941 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021942
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021943 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21944 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021945 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021946 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21947 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21948 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21949 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21950 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21951 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021952
21953Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21954
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021955 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021956 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021957 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021958
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021959 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021960 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21961 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21962
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021963 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021964 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21965 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21966 flags.
21967
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021968 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21969 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021970 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21971 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21972 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21973 the client connection was maintained open.
21974
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021975 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021976 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021977 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021978 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21979
21980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219818.5. Session state at disconnection
21982-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021983
21984TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21985"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
219862-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21987each of which has a special meaning :
21988
21989 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21990 session to terminate :
21991
21992 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21993
21994 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21995 server explicitly refused it.
21996
21997 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21998 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21999 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
22000 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022001 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022002
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022003 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022004 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022005
22006 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
22007 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
22008 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
22009 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
22010 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
22011
22012 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
22013 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
22014 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
22015 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
22016 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
22017
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022018 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090022019 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
22020
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022021 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070022022 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
22023 backup connections when going up.
22024
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022025 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020022026
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022027 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
22028 send or receive data.
22029
22030 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
22031 send or receive data.
22032
22033 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
22034 with nothing left in the buffers.
22035
22036 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
22037
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010022038 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022039 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
22040
22041 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
22042 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
22043 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
22044 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
22045 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
22046
22047 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
22048 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
22049
22050 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
22051 server (HTTP only).
22052
22053 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
22054
22055 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
22056 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
22057 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
22058
22059 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
22060 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
22061 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
22062
22063 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
22064
22065 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
22066 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
22067
22068 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
22069 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
22070 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
22071
22072 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
22073 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020022074 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
22075 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022076
22077 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
22078 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
22079 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
22080 another server.
22081
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022082 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022083 server.
22084
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022085 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
22086 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
22087 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
22088 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22089
22090 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
22091 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
22092 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
22093 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22094
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020022095 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
22096 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
22097 "use-server" rule).
22098
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022099 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22100
22101 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
22102 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
22103
22104 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
22105
22106 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
22107 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
22108 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
22109
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022110 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
22111 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022112 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022113 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
22114 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
22115
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022116 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
22117
22118 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
22119 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
22120
22121 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
22122
22123 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22124
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022125The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
22126was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022127helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
22128starvation, attacks, etc...
22129
22130The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
22131alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22132easier finding and understanding.
22133
22134 Flags Reason
22135
22136 -- Normal termination.
22137
22138 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022139 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22140 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022141 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22142
22143 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22144 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022145 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
22146 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022147 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
22148 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022149
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022150 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22151 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022152 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022153
22154 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
22155 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
22156 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
22157
22158 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
22159 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
22160 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
22161 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
22162 the server takes too long to respond.
22163
22164 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
22165 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
22166 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
22167 long a time to respond.
22168
22169 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
22170 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
22171 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022172 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022173 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
22174 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022175
22176 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
22177 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
22178 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
22179 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
22180 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020022181 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022182 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
22183 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22184 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22185 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22186 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22187 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22188 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22189 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022190 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022191 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22192 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22193 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022194
22195 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22196 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022197 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22198 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22199 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22200 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022201
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022202 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022203 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22204
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022205 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022206 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22207 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022208 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022209 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22210 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22211
22212 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22213 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22214 503 or 504 here.
22215
22216 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022217 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022218 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22219 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22220 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22221
22222 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22223 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022224 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022225 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022226 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022227
22228 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22229 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22230 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22231 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
22232 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
22233 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022234 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022235
22236 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
22237 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
22238 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
22239 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
22240 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
22241 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
22242 solution is to fix the application.
22243
22244 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22245 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22246 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22247 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22248 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22249 external attacks.
22250
22251 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022252 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022253 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022254 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22255 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22256
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022257 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22258 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22259 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022260 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022261 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022262
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022263 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22264 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22265 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22266 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022267 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22268 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22269 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22270 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
22271 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022272
22273 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22274 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22275 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
22276 returned an HTTP 403 error.
22277
22278 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22279 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22280 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22281 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22282
22283 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22284 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22285 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22286 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22287
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022288The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022289persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022290important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22291re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22292
22293 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22294
22295 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22296 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22297 set on a GET request.
22298
22299 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22300 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022301 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022302 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22303
22304 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22305 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22306 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22307
22308 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22309 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22310 already got a cookie.
22311
22312 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22313 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22314 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22315 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22316 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22317
22318 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22319 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22320 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22321
22322 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22323 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22324 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22325
22326 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22327 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22328
22329 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22330 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22331 then advertised in the response.
22332
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223348.6. Non-printable characters
22335-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022336
22337In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22338consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22339converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22340prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22341being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22342escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22343is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22344'}' when logging headers.
22345
22346Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22347issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22348containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22349
22350Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22351the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22352performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22353
22354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223558.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22356---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022357
22358Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22359achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022360section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022361cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22362the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22363the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022364locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022365not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22366user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22367a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22368wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22369
22370 Examples :
22371 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22372 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22373
22374 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22375 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22376
22377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223788.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22379---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022380
22381Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22382proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22383the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22384server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22385
22386Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22387response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022388section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022389
22390It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022391time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22392appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022393are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22394and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22395follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22396request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22397in the logs.
22398
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022399As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22400frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22401an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22402
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022403 Example :
22404 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22405 listen proxy-out
22406 mode http
22407 option httplog
22408 option logasap
22409 log global
22410 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22411
22412 # log the name of the virtual server
22413 capture request header Host len 20
22414
22415 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22416 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22417
22418 # log the beginning of the referrer
22419 capture request header Referer len 20
22420
22421 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22422 capture response header Server len 20
22423
22424 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22425 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22426
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022427 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022428 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22429
22430 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22431 capture response header Via len 20
22432
22433 # log the URL location during a redirection
22434 capture response header Location len 20
22435
22436 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22437 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22438 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22439 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22440 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22441
22442 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22443 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22444 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22445 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022446 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022447
22448 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22449 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22450 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22451 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22452 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022453 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022454
22455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200224568.9. Examples of logs
22457---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022458
22459These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22460them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22461reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22462
22463 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22464 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22465 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22466
22467 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22468 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22469
22470 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22471 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22472 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22473
22474 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22475 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22476
22477 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22478 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22479 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22480
22481 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022482 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022483 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22484 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22485
22486 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22487 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22488 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22489
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022490 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22491 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22492 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22493 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022494 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022495 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022496
22497 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022498 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022499
22500 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22501 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22502 Nothing was sent to any server.
22503
22504 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22505 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22506
22507 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22508 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022509 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022510 send a 408 return code to the client.
22511
22512 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22513 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22514
22515 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22516 5 seconds ("c----").
22517
22518 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22519 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022520 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022521
22522 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022523 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022524 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22525 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22526 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22527 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22528 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022529
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022530
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200225319. Supported filters
22532--------------------
22533
22534Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22535accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22536unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22537
22538See also : "filter"
22539
225409.1. Trace
22541----------
22542
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022543filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022544
22545 Arguments:
22546 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22547 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22548
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022549 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022550
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022551 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022552 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22553 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22554 amount of the parsed data.
22555
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022556 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022557
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022558This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22559callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22560information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22561filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22562
22563Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22564tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22565a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22566
22567
225689.2. HTTP compression
22569---------------------
22570
22571filter compression
22572
22573The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22574keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022575when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22576fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22577done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22578explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22579filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22580listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22581order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022582
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022583See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22584 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022585
22586
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200225879.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22588--------------------------------------------
22589
22590filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22591
22592 Arguments :
22593
22594 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22595 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22596 parsed.
22597
22598 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22599 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22600 part must be placed in its own scope.
22601
22602The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22603external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022604streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022605exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22606also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22607
22608SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22609the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22610
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022611For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022612"doc/SPOE.txt".
22613
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100226149.4. Cache
22615----------
22616
22617filter cache <name>
22618
22619 Arguments :
22620
22621 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22622
22623The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22624"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022625cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022626other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22627case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22628is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22629filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022630listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22631order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022632
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022633See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22634 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22635
22636
226379.5. Fcgi-app
22638-------------
22639
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022640filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022641
22642 Arguments :
22643
22644 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22645
22646The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22647request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22648reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22649used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22650implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22651used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22652fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22653used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22654order.
22655
22656See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22657 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22658
22659
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100226609.6. OpenTracing
22661----------------
22662
22663The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22664HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22665of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22666Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22667
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022668This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022669
22670The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22671HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22672participates in the work of HAProxy.
22673
22674filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22675
22676 Arguments :
22677
22678 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22679 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22680 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22681 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22682 OpenTracing filters.
22683
22684 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22685 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22686 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22687 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22688 filter must have its own scope defined.
22689
22690More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022691of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022692
22693
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002269410. FastCGI applications
22695-------------------------
22696
22697HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22698feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22699the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22700FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22701servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22702FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22703backend.
22704
22705HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22706application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22707connection.
22708
2270910.1. Setup
22710-----------
22711
2271210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22713--------------------------
22714
22715fcgi-app <name>
22716 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22717 document root must be defined.
22718
22719acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22720 Declare or complete an access list.
22721
22722 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22723 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22724 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22725 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22726 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22727
22728docroot <path>
22729 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22730 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22731 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22732
22733index <script-name>
22734 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22735 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22736 is an optional setting.
22737
22738 Example :
22739 index index.php
22740
22741log-stderr global
22742log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022743 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022744 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22745
22746 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22747 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22748
22749pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22750 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22751 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22752 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22753
22754 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22755 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22756 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22757 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22758
22759 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22760 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22761
22762path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022763 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022764 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22765 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22766 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22767 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22768 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22769 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22770 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022771
22772 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022773 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022774 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22775 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22776 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22777 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022778
22779 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022780 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22781 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022782
22783option get-values
22784no option get-values
22785 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22786
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022787 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022788 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22789
22790 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22791 application will accept.
22792
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022793 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22794 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022795
22796 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022797 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022798 option is disabled.
22799
22800 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22801 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22802 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22803 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22804 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22805 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22806
22807option keep-conn
22808no option keep-conn
22809 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22810 sending a response.
22811
22812 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22813 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22814
22815option max-reqs <reqs>
22816 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22817 accept.
22818
22819 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22820 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22821 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22822 to 1.
22823
22824option mpxs-conns
22825no option mpxs-conns
22826 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22827
22828 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22829 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22830
22831set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22832 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22833 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22834 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22835 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22836
22837 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22838 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22839 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22840
22841 Example :
22842 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22843 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22844
22845 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22846
22847
2284810.1.2. Proxy section
22849---------------------
22850
22851use-fcgi-app <name>
22852 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22853
22854 Arguments :
22855 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22856
22857 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22858 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22859 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22860 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22861 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22862
22863 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22864 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22865 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22866 application are evaluated.
22867
22868
2286910.1.3. Example
22870---------------
22871
22872 frontend front-http
22873 mode http
22874 bind *:80
22875 bind *:
22876
22877 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22878 default_backend back-static
22879
22880 backend back-static
22881 mode http
22882 server www A.B.C.D:80
22883
22884 backend back-dynamic
22885 mode http
22886 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22887 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22888
22889 fcgi-app php-fpm
22890 log-stderr global
22891 option keep-conn
22892
22893 docroot /var/www/my-app
22894 index index.php
22895 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22896
22897
2289810.2. Default parameters
22899------------------------
22900
22901A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22902the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022903script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022904applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22905
22906 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22907 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22908 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22909 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22910 | | |
22911 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22912 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22913 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22914 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22915 | | application. |
22916 | | |
22917 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22918 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22919 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22920 | | |
22921 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22922 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22923 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22924 | | the application's configuration. |
22925 | | |
22926 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22927 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22928 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22929 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22930 | | |
22931 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22932 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22933 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22934 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22935 | | be defined. |
22936 | | |
22937 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22938 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22939 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22940 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22941 | | is not set too. |
22942 | | |
22943 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22944 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22945 | | set. |
22946 | | |
22947 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22948 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22949 | | the request. |
22950 | | |
22951 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22952 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22953 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22954 | | |
22955 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22956 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22957 | | script to process the request. |
22958 | | |
22959 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22960 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22961 | | |
22962 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22963 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22964 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22965 | | |
22966 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22967 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22968 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22969 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22970 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22971 | | |
22972 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22973 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22974 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22975 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22976 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22977 | | side. |
22978 | | |
22979 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22980 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22981 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22982 | | connected to. |
22983 | | |
22984 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22985 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22986 | | |
22987 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022988 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22989 | | current HAProxy version. |
22990 | | |
22991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022992 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22993 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22994 | | |
22995 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22996
22997
2299810.3. Limitations
22999------------------
23000
23001The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
23002way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
23003during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
23004establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
23005application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
23006or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
23007message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
23008these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
23009and HTTP servers under the same backend.
23010
23011Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
23012request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
23013requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
23014
23015About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
23016into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
23017fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
23018"http-request" ones.
23019
23020Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
23021FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
23022processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
23023must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
23024here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010023025
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020023026
2302711. Address formats
23028-------------------
23029
23030Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
23031address.
23032
23033This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
23034The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
23035of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
23036equivalent is '::'.
23037
23038Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
23039is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
23040
23041This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
23042family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
23043
23044Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
23045configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
23046use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
23047'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
23048
23049Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
23050socket type and the transport method.
23051
23052
2305311.1 Address family prefixes
23054----------------------------
23055
23056'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
23057
23058'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
23059 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
23060 listening.
23061
23062'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
23063 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
23064 on the statement using this address, a port or
23065 a port range may or must be specified.
23066
23067'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23068 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
23069 using this address, a port or a port range
23070 may or must be specified.
23071
23072'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23073 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
23074 using this address, a port or a port range
23075 may or must be specified.
23076
23077'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
23078 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
23079 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
23080 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
23081 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
23082 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
23083
23084'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
23085 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
23086 start by slash '/'.
23087
23088
2308911.2 Socket type prefixes
23090-------------------------
23091
23092Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
23093type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
23094this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
23095This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
23096but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
23097
23098Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
23099instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
23100
23101If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
23102they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
23103report this to the maintainers.
23104
23105'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23106 to "stream"
23107
23108'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23109 to "datagram".
23110
23111
2311211.3 Protocol prefixes
23113----------------------
23114
23115'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23116 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23117 socket type and transport method is forced to
23118 "stream". Depending on the statement using
23119 this address, a port or a port range can or
23120 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23121 of 'stream+ip@'.
23122
23123'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23124 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23125 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23126 statement using this address, a port or port
23127 range can or must be specified.
23128 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23129
23130'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23131 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23132 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23133 statement using this address, a port or port
23134 range can or must be specified.
23135 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23136
23137'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23138 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23139 socket type and transport method is forced to
23140 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
23141 this address, a port or a port range can or
23142 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23143 of 'dgram+ip@'.
23144
23145'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23146 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23147 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23148 the statement using this address, a port or
23149 port range can or must be specified.
23150 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23151
23152'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23153 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23154 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23155 the statement using this address, a port or
23156 port range can or must be specified.
23157 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23158
23159'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23160 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
23161 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
23162
23163'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23164 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
23165 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
23166
23167In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
23168QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
23169
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010023170/*
23171 * Local variables:
23172 * fill-column: 79
23173 * End:
23174 */